Mercurial > vim
annotate runtime/doc/todo.txt @ 3404:38a135730423 v7.3.468
updated for version 7.3.468
Problem: For some compilers the error file is not easily readable.
Solution: Use QuickFixCmdPre for more commands. (Marcin Szamotulski)
author | Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org> |
---|---|
date | Wed, 07 Mar 2012 20:13:49 +0100 |
parents | 8dcf3ea92b63 |
children | 94601b379f38 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
3371 | 1 *todo.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Feb 22 |
7 | 2 |
3 | |
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar | |
5 | |
6 | |
7 TODO list for Vim *todo* | |
8 | |
9 This is a veeeery long list of known bugs, current work and desired | |
10 improvements. To make it a little bit accessible, the items are grouped by | |
11 subject. In the first column of the line a classification is used to be able | |
12 to look for "the next thing to do": | |
13 | |
14 Priority classification: | |
15 9 next point release | |
16 8 next release | |
17 7 as soon as possible | |
18 6 soon | |
19 5 should be included | |
20 4 nice to have | |
21 3 consider including | |
22 2 maybe not | |
23 1 probably not | |
24 - unclassified | |
25 | |
26 *votes-for-changes* | |
27 See |develop.txt| for development plans. You can vote for which items should | |
28 be worked on, but only if you sponsor Vim development. See |sponsor|. | |
29 | |
2908 | 30 Issues can also be entered online: http://code.google.com/p/vim/issues/list |
31 Updates will be forwarded to the vim_dev maillist. Issues entered there will | |
32 not be repeated below, unless there is extra information. | |
33 | |
7 | 34 *known-bugs* |
35 -------------------- Known bugs and current work ----------------------- | |
36 | |
3224 | 37 Go through more coverity reports. |
38 | |
39 Discussion about canonicalization of Hebrew. (Ron Aaron, 2011 April 10) | |
40 | |
3371 | 41 Stack trace of crash: http://vpaste.net/GBt9S |
42 (Alexandre Provencio) | |
43 | |
3153 | 44 Once syntax and other runtime files have been fixed: add "set cp" to |
45 check.vim. Use a function to run both with 'cp' and 'nocp'. | |
46 | |
3371 | 47 Undo broken when pasting close to the last line. (Andrey Radev, 2012 Feb 14) |
48 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2012 Feb 14. | |
49 | |
3356 | 50 GTK: problem with 'L' in 'guioptions' changing the window width. |
51 (Aaron Cornelius, 2012 Feb 6) | |
3256 | 52 |
53 Win32: When a directory name contains an exclamation mark, completion doesn't | |
54 complete the contents of the directory. No escaping for the "!"? (Jan | |
55 Stocker, 2012 Jan 5) | |
56 | |
3371 | 57 Patch to speed up ga_grow(). (Dominique Pelle, 2012 Feb 13) |
58 | |
3312 | 59 Patch for "tab drop hoge" moving current window. (Higashi, 2012 Jan 31) |
60 ":tab drop buffer.c" always opens a new tab, also if buffer.c is already in an | |
61 open window. (Herb Sitz, 2011 Nov 17) | |
62 ":tab drop filename" doesn't work nicely when "filename" is open in a window | |
63 in another tab. (Tony Mechelynck, 2009 Feb 13) | |
64 | |
3224 | 65 Patch to make InsertCharPre work better. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2011 Oct 21) |
66 | |
67 Patch to fix closed folds with "loadview". (Xavier de Gaye, 2011 Nov 25) | |
68 | |
3153 | 69 Patch to add getsid(). (Tyru, 2011 Oct 2) Do we want this? Update Oct 4. |
70 Or use expand('<sid>')? | |
71 | |
3082 | 72 Patch for glob() returning a list. (Christian Brabandt, 2011 Aug 24, second |
73 one) | |
74 | |
3312 | 75 Win32: When the taskbar is at the top of the screen creating the tabbar causes |
76 the window to move unnecessarily. (William E. Skeith III, 2012 Jan 12) | |
77 Patch: 2012 Jan 13 Needs more work (2012 Feb 2) | |
78 | |
3153 | 79 Patch to highlight cursor line number. (Howard Buchholz (lhb), 2011 Oct 18) |
80 | |
3312 | 81 URXVT: |
82 - will get stuck if byte sequence does not containe expected semicolon. | |
83 - Patch for urxvt mouse support after shell command. (Issue 31) | |
84 - Use urxvt mouse support also in xterm. Explanations: | |
85 http://www.midnight-commander.org/ticket/2662 | |
86 | |
87 Patch for using QuickFixCmdPre for more commands. (Marcin Szamotulski, 2012 | |
88 Feb 1, update Feb 2) | |
89 | |
3371 | 90 Patch for pasting in the Ex command line is slow. (Dominique Pelle, 2012 Feb |
91 19) | |
92 | |
3312 | 93 When running Vim in silent ex mode, an existing swapfile causes Vim to wait |
94 for a user action without a prompt. (Maarten Billemont, 2012 Feb 3) | |
95 Do give the prompt? Quit with an error? | |
3224 | 96 |
3237 | 97 When exiting with unsaved changes, selecting an existing file in the file |
98 dialog, there is no dialog to ask whether the existing file should be | |
99 overwritten. (Felipe G. Nievinski, 2011 Dec 22) | |
100 | |
3371 | 101 Patch for improved ":qa" behavior. (Hirohito Higashi, 2012 Feb 18) |
102 | |
103 Recognize objcpp. (Austin Ziegler, 2012 Feb 15) | |
104 | |
3224 | 105 7 Setting an option always sets "w_set_curswant", while this is only |
106 required for a few options. Only do it for those options to avoid the | |
107 side effect. | |
108 Patch by Kana Natsuno, 2011 Nov 12. | |
109 | |
3281 | 110 Patch to fix member confusion in Lua interface. (Taro Muraoka, 2012 Jan 8) |
111 Update Jan 9. | |
112 Carvalho merged the patch: New version 2012 Jan 19. | |
113 | |
3224 | 114 Patch for option in 'cino' to specify more indent for continued conditions. |
115 (Lech Lorens, 2011 Nov 27) | |
3371 | 116 Isn't this already possible? Update 2012 Feb 15. |
3224 | 117 |
3237 | 118 Patch for using objcpp file type for headers files. Issue 44. |
119 | |
3153 | 120 Docs fix for v:register. (Ingo Karkat, 2011 Sep 26, 27) |
121 v:register doesn't work exactly as expected. (David Fishburn, 2011 Sep 20) | |
122 | |
3356 | 123 Patch for: vimgrep fails when 'autochdir' is set. (Ben Fritz, 2012 Feb 4) |
124 | |
3082 | 125 Patch for: (Christian Brabandt, 2011 Aug 22) |
126 - Make it possible to enter "r<C-E>" and "r<C-Y>" (get character from line | |
127 below/above). | |
128 | |
129 Patch for: (Christian Brabandt, 2011 Aug 24, updated patch) | |
130 8 ":sign unplace * file={filename}" should work. Also: ":sign unplace * | |
131 buffer={bufnr}". So one can remove all signs for one file/buffer. | |
132 | |
3153 | 133 Patch to add "onselected" callback for completion. (Taro Muraoka, 2011 Sep 24) |
3312 | 134 Another for CompleteFuncOk. (Florian Klein, 2012 Jan 31) |
135 Name it "CompleteFuncDone". | |
136 | |
137 Patch for Make_mvc.mak and Make_ming.mak for Ruby support. (Yasuhiro | |
138 Matsumoto, 2012 Jan 30) | |
3153 | 139 |
3237 | 140 Use a count before "v" and "V" to select that many characters or lines? |
141 (Kikyous) | |
142 | |
3099
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
143 Problem with winfixheight and resizing. (Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2011 Sep 17) |
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
144 Patch Sep 18. |
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
145 |
3153 | 146 Patch for has('unnamedplus') docs. (Tony Mechelynck, 2011 Sep 27) |
147 And one for gui_x11.txt. | |
148 | |
3356 | 149 ":cd" doesn't work when current directory path contains "**". |
150 finddir() has the same problem. (Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2012 Jan 10) | |
151 Requires a rewrite of the file_file_in_path code. | |
152 | |
3082 | 153 Problem with l: dictionary being locked in a function. (ZyX, 2011 Jul 21) |
2751 | 154 |
3281 | 155 Issue 48: foldopen error can't be caught by try/catch |
156 | |
3153 | 157 Patch to sort functions starting with '<' after others. Omit dict functions, |
158 they can't be called. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2011 Oct 11) | |
159 | |
3356 | 160 Patch to pass list to or(), and() and xor(). (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2012 Feb 8) |
161 | |
3224 | 162 Patch to improve "it" and "at" text object matching. (Christian Brabandt, 2011 |
163 Nov 20) | |
164 | |
165 `[ moves to character after insert, instead of the last inserted character. | |
166 (Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2011 Dec 9) | |
167 | |
168 Plugin for Modeleasy. (Massimiliano Tripoli, 2011 Nov 29) | |
169 | |
3153 | 170 Updated syntax file for ssh_config, maintainer doesn't respond. |
171 (Leonard Ehrenfried, 2011 Sep 26) | |
172 | |
3371 | 173 BufWinLeave triggers too late when quitting last window in a tab page. (Lech |
174 Lorens, 2012 Feb 21) | |
175 | |
3153 | 176 "fC" doesn't position the cursor correctly when there are concealed |
177 characters. Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2011 Oct 11) | |
178 | |
3224 | 179 Patch for 'transparency' option. (Sergiu Dotenco, 2011 Sep 17) |
180 Only for MS-Windows. No documentation. Do we want this? | |
181 | |
3237 | 182 Patch to support cursor shape in Cygwin console. (Ben bgold, 2011 Dec 27) |
183 | |
3256 | 184 Patch to support UTF-8 for Hangul. (Shawn Y.H. Kim, 2011 May 1) |
185 Needs more work. Pinged 2012 Jan 4. | |
186 | |
2751 | 187 'cursorline' is displayed too short when there are concealed characters and |
188 'list' is set. (Dennis Preiser) | |
189 Patch 7.3.116 was the wrong solution. | |
2965 | 190 Christian Brabandt has another incomplete patch. (2011 Jul 13) |
2751 | 191 |
2908 | 192 With concealed text mouse click doesn't put the cursor in the right position. |
193 (Herb Sitz) Fix by Christian Brabandt, 2011 Jun 16. Doesn't work properly, | |
194 need to make the change in where RET_WIN_BUF_CHARTABSIZE() is called. | |
195 | |
196 Syntax region with 'concealends' and a 'cchar' value, 'conceallevel' set to 2, | |
197 only one of the two ends gets the cchar displayed. (Brett Stahlman, 2010 Aug | |
198 21, Ben Fritz, 2010 Sep 14) | |
199 | |
3224 | 200 Win32: Patch to use task dialogs when available. (Sergiu Dotenco, 2011 Sep 17) |
201 New feature, requires testing. Made some remarks. | |
202 | |
203 Win32: Patch for alpha-blended icons and toolbar height. (Sergiu Dotenco, 2011 | |
204 Sep 17) Asked for feedback from others. | |
205 | |
3281 | 206 Win32: Cannot cd into a directory that starts with a space. (Andy Wokula, 2012 |
207 Jan 19) | |
208 | |
3082 | 209 Need to escape $HOME on Windows? (ZyX, 2011 Jul 21) |
2751 | 210 |
3224 | 211 "2" in 'formatopions' not working in comments. (Christian Corneliussen, 2011 |
212 Oct 26) | |
213 | |
2751 | 214 Bug in repeating Visual "u". (Lawrence Kesteloot, 2010 Dec 20) |
215 | |
3082 | 216 With "unamedplus" in 'clipboard' pasting in Visual mode causes error for empty |
217 register. (Michael Seiwald, 2011 Jun 28) I can't reproduce it. | |
2908 | 218 |
2788 | 219 In GTK Gvim, setting 'lines' and 'columns' to 99999 causes a crash (Tony |
220 Mechelynck, 2011 Apr 25). Can reproduce the crash sometimes: | |
221 gvim -N -u NONE --cmd 'set lines=99999 columns=99999' | |
222 (gvim:25968): Gdk-WARNING **: Native Windows wider or taller than 65535 pixels are not supported | |
223 The program 'gvim' received an X Window System error. | |
224 This probably reflects a bug in the program. | |
225 The error was 'RenderBadPicture (invalid Picture parameter)'. | |
226 (Details: serial 313 error_code 161 request_code 149 minor_code 8) | |
227 (Note to programmers: normally, X errors are reported asynchronously; | |
228 that is, you will receive the error a while after causing it. | |
229 To debug your program, run it with the --sync command line | |
230 option to change this behavior. You can then get a meaningful | |
231 backtrace from your debugger if you break on the gdk_x_error() function.) | |
232 Check that number of pixels doesn't go above 65535? | |
233 | |
2965 | 234 popup completion menu closes quickly when there is a fold in the buffer. (Jan |
235 Christoph Ebersbach, 2011 Jul 3) | |
236 | |
2751 | 237 Windows keys not set properly on Windows 7? (cncyber, 2010 Aug 26) |
238 | |
239 This line hangs Vim, because of syntax HL: | |
240 call append(line, "INFO ....12....18....24....30....36....42....48....54....60....66....72....78%$") | |
241 | |
242 When using a Vim server, a # in the path causes an error message. | |
243 (Jeff Lanzarotta, 2011 Feb 17) | |
244 | |
3224 | 245 Setting $HOME on MS-Windows is not very well documented. Suggestion by Ben |
246 Fritz (2011 Oct 27). | |
247 | |
2751 | 248 Bug: E685 error for func_unref(). (ZyX, 2010 Aug 5) |
249 | |
2908 | 250 Bug: Windows 7 64 bit system freezes when 'clipboard' set to "unnamed" and |
251 doing ":g/test/d". Putting every delete on the clipboard? (Robert Chan, 2011 | |
252 Jun 17) | |
253 | |
2751 | 254 Using ":break" or something else that stops executing commands inside a |
255 ":finally" does not rethrow a previously uncaught exception. (ZyX, 2010 Oct | |
256 15) | |
257 | |
258 Vim using lots of memory when joining lines. (John Little, 2010 Dec 3) | |
259 | |
3082 | 260 Changes to manpage plugin. (Elias Toivanen, 2011 Jul 25) |
261 | |
2751 | 262 On 64 bit MS-Windows "long" is only 32 bits, but we sometimes need to store a |
263 64 bits value. Change all number options to use nropt_T and define it to the | |
264 right type. | |
265 | |
266 string() can't parse back "inf" and "nan". Fix documentation or fix code? | |
267 (ZyX, 2010 Aug 23) | |
268 | |
3082 | 269 Make 'formatprg' global-local. (Sung Pae) |
270 | |
2751 | 271 When doing "redir => s:foo" in a script and then "redir END" somewhere else |
272 (e.g. in a function) it can't find s:foo. | |
273 | |
3099
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
274 When setqflist() uses a filename that triggers a BufReadCmd autocommand Vim |
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
275 doesn't jump to the correct line with :cfirst. (ZyX, 2011 Sep 18) |
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
276 |
3082 | 277 7 Make "ga" show the digraph for a character, if it exists. |
278 Patch from Christian Brabandt, 2011 Aug 19. | |
279 | |
2751 | 280 maparg() does not show the <script> flag. When temporarily changing a |
281 mapping, how to restore the script ID? | |
282 | |
283 Bug in try/catch: return with invalid compare throws error that isn't caught. | |
284 (ZyX, 2011 Jan 26) | |
285 | |
286 Highlighting stops working after changing it many times. Script to reproduce | |
287 it: Pablo Contreras, 2010 Oct 12 Windows XP and 7. Font is never freed? | |
288 | |
2965 | 289 When setting a local option value from the global value, add a script ID that |
290 indicates this, so that ":verbose set" can give a hint. Check with options in | |
291 the help file. | |
292 | |
2751 | 293 After patch 7.3.097 still get E15. (Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2011 Jan 18) |
294 Also for another example (ZyX, 2011 Jan 24) | |
295 | |
296 Build problem with small features on Mac OS X 10.6. (Rainer, 2011 Jan 24) | |
297 | |
298 "0g@$" puts '] on last byte of multi-byte. (ZyX, 2011 Jan 22) | |
299 | |
300 Patch to support sorting on floating point number. (Alex Jakushev, 2010 Oct | |
301 30) | |
302 | |
2908 | 303 Patch to addd TextDeletePost and TextYankPost events. (Philippe Vaucher, 2011 |
304 May 24) Update May 26. | |
305 | |
3312 | 306 Patch for :tabrecently. (Hirokazu Yoshida, 2012 Jan 30) |
307 | |
2751 | 308 When a script contains "redir => s:foo" but doesn't end redirection, a |
309 following "redir" command gives an error for not being able to access s:foo. | |
310 (ZyX, 2011 Mar 27) | |
311 | |
312 Problem with "syn sync gouphere". (Gustavo Niemeyer, 2011 Jan 27) | |
313 | |
314 Loading autoload script even when usage is inside "if 0". (Christian Brabandt, | |
315 2010 Dec 18) | |
316 | |
2908 | 317 With a filler line in diff mode, it isn't displayed in the column with line |
318 number, but it is in the sign column. Doesn't look right. (ZyX 2011 Jun 5) | |
319 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2011 Jun 5. Introduces new problems. | |
320 | |
3082 | 321 8 Add a command to jump to the next character highlighted with "Error". |
322 Patch by Christian Brabandt, uses ]e [e ]t and [t. 2011 Aug 9. | |
323 | |
324 8 Add an event like CursorHold that is triggered repeatedly, not just once | |
325 after typing something. | |
326 Need for CursorHold that retriggers. Use a key that doesn't do anything, or a | |
327 function that resets did_cursorhold. | |
328 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2011 May 6. | |
329 | |
330 7 Use "++--", "+++--" for different levels instead of "+---" "+----". | |
331 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2011 Jul 27. | |
332 Update by Ben Fritz, with fix for TOhtml. (2011 Jul 30) | |
333 | |
334 9 Add %F to 'errorformat': file name without spaces. Useful on Unix to | |
335 avoid matching something up to a time 11:22:33. | |
336 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2011 Jul 27. | |
337 | |
338 Patch to fix \%V item in regexp. (Christian Brabandt, 2010 Nov 8) | |
339 Update Nov 19. James Vega: still not right. Christian: it's difficult. | |
340 | |
341 Patch to add up to 99 match groups. (Christian Brabandt, 2010 Dec 22) | |
342 Also add named groups: \%{name}(re) and \%{name}g | |
343 | |
2751 | 344 In the sandbox it's not allowed to do many things, but it's possible to change |
345 or set variables. Add a way to prevent variables from being changed in the | |
346 sandbox? E.g.: ":protect g:restore_settings". | |
347 | |
348 GTK: drawing a double-width combining character over single-width characters | |
349 doesn't look right. (Dominique Pelle, 2010 Aug 8) | |
350 | |
351 GTK: tear-off menu does not work. (Kurt Sonnenmoser, 2010 Oct 25) | |
352 | |
353 Win32: tear-off menu does not work when menu language is German. (Markus | |
354 Bossler, 2011 Mar 2) Fixed by 7.3.095? | |
355 | |
356 Version of netbeans.c for use with MacVim. (Kazuki Sakamoto, 2010 Nov 18) | |
357 | |
358 7.3.014 changed how backslash at end of line works, but still get a NUL when | |
359 there is one backslash. (Ray Frush, 2010 Nov 18) What does the original ex | |
360 do? | |
361 | |
362 Searching mixed with Visual mode doesn't redraw properly. (James Vega, 2010 Nov | |
363 22) | |
364 | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
365 New esperanto spell file can't be processed. (Dominique Pelle, 2011 Jan 30) |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
366 - move compflags to separate growarray? |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
367 - instead of a regexp use a hashtable. Expand '?', '*", '+'. What would be |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
368 the maximum repeat for * and +? |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
369 |
2725 | 370 "L'Italie" noted as a spell error at start of the sentence. (Dominique Pelle, |
371 2011 Feb 27) | |
372 | |
2596 | 373 Copy/paste between Vim and Google chrome doesn't work well for multi-byte |
2581 | 374 characters. (Ben Haskell, 2010 Sep 17) |
2596 | 375 When putting text in the cut buffer (when exiting) and conversion doesn't work |
376 properly, Prepend "ENC==={value of 'enc'}:" to the text and don't convert? | |
377 Then it should at least work from Vim to Vim and in other applications it's | |
378 clear why it doesn't work. | |
2581 | 379 |
2152 | 380 Editing a file with a ^M with 'ff' set to "mac", opening a help file, then the |
381 ^M is displayed as ^J sometimes. Getting 'ff' value from wrong window/buffer? | |
382 | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
383 When Vim is put in the background (SIGTSTP) and then gets a SIGHUP it doesn't |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
384 exit. It exists as soon as back in the foreground. (Stephen Liang, 2011 Jan |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
385 9) Caused by vim_handle_signal(SIGNAL_BLOCK); in ui.c. |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
386 |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
387 g` not working correctly when using :edit. It works OK when editing a file on |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
388 the command line. (Ingo Karkat, 2011 Jan 25) |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
389 |
2662 | 390 Since patch 7.2.46 Yankring plugin has become very slow, eventually make Vim |
391 crash? (Raiwil, 2010 Nov 17) | |
392 | |
2681 | 393 Python: Adding line to buffer other than the current one doesn't work |
394 correctly. (Rozbujnik, 2010 Dec 19) | |
395 | |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
396 Patch to add 'systemencoding', convert between 'encoding' and this for file |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
397 names, shell commands and the like. (Kikuchan, 2010 Oct 14) |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
398 Assume the system converts between the actual encoding of the filesystem to |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
399 the system encoding (usually utf-8). |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
400 |
2152 | 401 Problem producing tags file when hebrew.frx is present. It has a BOM. |
402 Results in E670. (Tony Mechelynck, 2010 May 2) | |
403 | |
3153 | 404 'beval' option should be global-local. |
405 | |
2642 | 406 Ruby: ":ruby print $buffer.number" returns zero. |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
407 |
2564
f85004953416
README and help file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
408 setpos() does not restore cursor position after :normal. (Tyru, 2010 Aug 11) |
2553
37d3f90f5203
Conceal feature caused the 'cursorline' highlighting to stop early.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2542
diff
changeset
|
409 |
2625 | 410 7 The 'directory' option supports changing path separators to "%" to make |
411 file names unique, also support this for 'backupdir'. (Mikolaj Machowski) | |
412 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2010 Oct 21. | |
413 | |
2581 | 414 getpos()/setpos() don't include curswant. getpos() could return a fifth |
415 element. setpos() could accept an optional fifth element. | |
416 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2010 Sep 6. Check that new argument is optional | |
417 and that it's documented. | |
418 | |
2625 | 419 With "tw=55 fo+=a" typing space before ) doesn't work well. (Scott Mcdermott, |
420 2010 Oct 24) | |
421 | |
2642 | 422 Patch to add random number generator. (Hong Xu, 2010 Nov 8, update Nov 10) |
423 Alternative from Christian Brabandt. (2010 Sep 19) | |
424 | |
2581 | 425 Messages in message.txt are highlighted as examples. |
426 | |
2625 | 427 When using cp850 the NBSP (0xff) is not drawn correctly. (Brett Stahlman, 2010 |
428 Oct 22) 'isprint' is set to "@,161-255". | |
429 | |
2559
7850c8c12347
Cleanup in :find completion code. Make it work for "./subdir" in 'path'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2556
diff
changeset
|
430 Test 73 fails on MS-Windows when compiled with DJGPP and run twice. How to |
7850c8c12347
Cleanup in :find completion code. Make it work for "./subdir" in 'path'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2556
diff
changeset
|
431 delete the Xfind directory? Add an rmdir() function, just like we have |
7850c8c12347
Cleanup in :find completion code. Make it work for "./subdir" in 'path'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2556
diff
changeset
|
432 mkdir(). |
7850c8c12347
Cleanup in :find completion code. Make it work for "./subdir" in 'path'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2556
diff
changeset
|
433 |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
434 ":echo "\x85" =~# '[\u0085]'" returns 1 instead of 0. (ZyX, 2010 Oct 3) |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
435 |
2152 | 436 'cindent' not correct when 'list' is set. (Zdravi Korusef, 2010 Apr 15) |
437 | |
3256 | 438 C-indenting: A matching { in a comment is ignored, but intermediate { are not |
439 checked to be in a comment. Implement FM_SKIPCOMM flag of findmatchlimit(). | |
440 Issue 46. | |
441 | |
2681 | 442 When 'paste' is changed with 'pastetoggle', the ruler doesn't reflect this |
443 right away. (Samuel Ferencik, 2010 Dec 7) | |
444 | |
2581 | 445 Mac with X11: clipboard doesn't work properly. (Raf, 2010 Aug 16) |
446 | |
2681 | 447 Using CompilerSet doesn't record where an option was set from. E.g., in the |
448 gcc compiler plugin. (Gary Johnson, 2010 Dec 13) | |
449 | |
2152 | 450 ":helpgrep" does not put the cursor in the correct column when preceded by |
451 accented character. (Tony Mechelynck, 2010 Apr 15) | |
452 | |
2581 | 453 Don't call check_restricted() for histadd(), setbufvar(), settabvar(), |
454 setwinvar(). | |
455 | |
2531 | 456 Echo starts in the wrong column: |
457 while 1 | let s = input('A') | echo 'R' | endw | |
458 (Boyko Bantchev, 2010 Aug 9) | |
459 | |
2642 | 460 Patch for GVimExt to show an icon. (Dominik Riebeling, 2010 Nov 7) |
461 | |
2681 | 462 When writing a file > 2Gbyte, the reported number of bytes is negative. |
463 (Antonio Colombo, 2010 Dec 18) | |
464 | |
2442 | 465 Patch: Let rare word highlighting overrule good word highlighting. |
2965 | 466 (Jakson A. Aquino, 2010 Jul 30, again 2011 Jul 2) |
2442 | 467 |
2581 | 468 When 'lines' is 25 and 'scrolloff' is 12, "j" scrolls zero or two lines |
469 instead of one. (Constantin Pan, 2010 Sep 10) | |
470 | |
2662 | 471 Crash in setqflist(). (Benoit Mortgat, 2010 Nov 18) |
472 | |
3082 | 473 Gui menu edit/paste in block mode insert only inserts in one line (Bjorn |
474 Winckler, 2011 May 11) | |
475 Requires a map mode for Insert mode started from blockwise Visual mode. | |
2681 | 476 |
2642 | 477 Writing nested List and Dict in viminfo gives error message and can't be read |
478 back. (Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2010 Nov 13) | |
479 | |
2681 | 480 Can 'undolevels' be a buffer-local option? Helps for making big changes in |
481 one file only, set 'ul' to -1 only for that buffer. | |
482 Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2010 Dec 17. Needs test. | |
483 | |
2120
f63ace015c63
Updated runtime and language files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2098
diff
changeset
|
484 Problem with cursor in the wrong column. (SungHyun Nam, 2010 Mar 11) |
2152 | 485 Additional info by Dominique Pelle. (also on 2010 Apr 10) |
486 | |
2642 | 487 CreateFile and CreateFileW are used without sharing, filewritable() fails when |
488 the file was already open (e.g. script is being sourced). Add FILE_SHARE_READ| | |
489 FILE_SHARE_WRITE in mch_access()? (Phillippe Vaucher, 2010 Nov 2) | |
490 | |
2152 | 491 Is ~/bin (literally) in $PATH supposed to work? (Paul, 2010 March 29) |
492 Looks like only bash can do it. (Yakov Lerner) | |
493 | |
2282
a888ed7ba375
Make updating text for conceal mode simpler. A few compiler warning fixes.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2280
diff
changeset
|
494 Cscope "cs add" stopped working somewhat before 7.2.438. (Gary Johnson, 2010 |
a888ed7ba375
Make updating text for conceal mode simpler. A few compiler warning fixes.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2280
diff
changeset
|
495 Jun 29) Caused by 7.2.433? |
a888ed7ba375
Make updating text for conceal mode simpler. A few compiler warning fixes.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2280
diff
changeset
|
496 |
2098
3259c3923c1e
Updated runtime an documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2072
diff
changeset
|
497 I often see pasted text (from Firefox, to Vim in xterm) appear twice. |
3259c3923c1e
Updated runtime an documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2072
diff
changeset
|
498 Also, Vim in xterm sometimes loses copy/paste ability (probably after running |
3259c3923c1e
Updated runtime an documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2072
diff
changeset
|
499 an external command). |
3259c3923c1e
Updated runtime an documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2072
diff
changeset
|
500 |
2152 | 501 Jumplist doesn't work properly in Insert mode? (Jean Johner, 2010 Mar 20) |
502 | |
2120
f63ace015c63
Updated runtime and language files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2098
diff
changeset
|
503 Problem with transparent cmdline. Also: Terminal title is wrong with |
f63ace015c63
Updated runtime and language files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
2098
diff
changeset
|
504 non-ASCII character. (Lily White, 2010 Mar 7) |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
505 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
506 iconv() doesn't fail on an illegal character, as documented. (Yongwei Wu, 2009 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
507 Nov 15, example Nov 26) Add argument to specify whether iconv() should fail |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
508 or replace with a character and continue? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
509 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
510 Add local time at start of --startuptime output. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
511 Requires configure check for localtime(). |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
512 Use format year-month-day hr:min:sec. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
513 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
514 Shell not recognized properly if it ends in "csh -f". (James Vega, 2009 Nov 3) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
515 Find tail? Might have a / in argument. Find space? Might have space in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
516 path. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
517 |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
518 Test 51 fails when language set to German. (Marco, 2011 Jan 9) |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
519 Dominique can't reproduc it. |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
520 |
2152 | 521 ":function f(x) keepjumps" creates a function where every command is executed |
522 like it has ":keepjumps" before it. | |
523 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
524 Coverity: ask someone to create new user: Dominique. |
2564
f85004953416
README and help file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
525 Check if there are new reported defects: http://scan.coverity.com/rung2.html |
f85004953416
README and help file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
526 |
2642 | 527 Patch to support :undo absolute jump to file save number. (Christian Brabandt, |
528 2010 Nov 5) | |
529 | |
2681 | 530 Patch to use 'foldnextmax' also for "marker" foldmethod. (Arnaud Lacombe, 2011 |
531 Jan 7) | |
532 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
533 Bug with 'incsearch' going to wrong line. (Wolfram Kresse, 2009 Aug 17) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
534 Only with "vim -u NONE". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
535 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
536 Problem with editing file in binary mode. (Ingo Krabbe, 2009 Oct 8) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
537 |
2709 | 538 With 'wildmode' set to "longest:full,full" and pressing Tab once the first |
539 entry in wildmenu is highlighted, that shouldn't happen. (Yuki Watanabe, 2011 | |
540 Feb 12) | |
541 | |
2561 | 542 Display error when 'tabline' that includes a file name with double-width |
543 characters. (2010 Aug 14, bootleq) | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
544 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
545 Problem with stop directory in findfile(). (Adam Simpkins, 2009 Aug 26) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
546 |
2965 | 547 Using ']' as the end of a range in a pattern requires double escaping: |
548 /[@-\\]] (Andy Wokula, 2011 Jun 28) | |
549 | |
2152 | 550 Undo problem: line not removed as expected when using setline() from Insert |
551 mode. (Israel Chauca, 2010 May 13, more in second msg) | |
552 Break undo when CTRL-R = changes the text? Or save more lines? | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
553 |
2225 | 554 Slow combination of folding and PHP syntax highlighting. Script to reproduce |
555 it. Caused by "syntax sync fromstart" in combination with patch 7.2.274. | |
556 (Christian Brabandt, 2010 May 27) | |
2662 | 557 Generally, folding with 'foldmethod' set to "syntax" is slow. Do profiling to |
558 find out why. | |
2225 | 559 |
3099
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
560 Syntax priority problem. (Charles Campbell, 2011 Sep 15) |
887d6d91882e
Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3082
diff
changeset
|
561 |
2262 | 562 When completion inserts the first match, it may trigger the line to be folded. |
563 Disable updating folds while completion is active? (Peter Odding, 2010 Jun 9) | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
564 |
2725 | 565 Using ":call foo#d.f()" doesn't autoload the "foo.vim" file. Works OK for |
566 echo, just not for ":call" and ":call call()". (Ted, 2011 Mar 17) | |
567 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
568 When a:base in 'completefunc' starts with a number it's passed as a number, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
569 not a string. (Sean Ma) Need to add flag to call_func_retlist() to force a |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
570 string value. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
571 |
2596 | 572 ":e ~br<Tab>" does not complete to ":e /home/bram/". Would need to use |
573 getpwent() to find all the matches. | |
574 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
575 Invalid read error in Farsi mode. (Dominique Pelle, 2009 Aug 2) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
576 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
577 For running gvim on an USB stick: avoid the OLE registration. Use a command |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
578 line argument -noregister. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
579 |
2642 | 580 When using an expression in 'statusline' leading white space sometimes goes |
581 missing (but not always). (ZyX, 2010 Nov 1) | |
582 | |
2152 | 583 When a mapping exists both for insert mode and lang-insert mode, the last one |
584 doesn't work. (Tyru, 2010 May 6) Or is this intended? | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
585 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
586 Still a problem with ":make" in the wrong directory. Caused by ":bufdo". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
587 (Ajit Thakkar, 2009 Jul 1) More information Jul 9, Jul 15. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
588 Caused by "doautoall syntaxset BufEnter *" in syntax/nosyntax.vim ? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
589 There also is a BufLeave/BufEnter aucmd to save/restore view. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
590 Does the patch to save/restore globaldir work? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
591 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
592 ":bufdo normal gg" while 'hidden' is set leaves buffers without syntax |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
593 highlighting. Don't disable Syntax autocommands then? Or add a flag/modifier |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
594 to avoid changing 'eventignore'? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
595 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
596 Patch for displaying 0x200c and 0x200d. (Ali Gholami Rudi, 2009 May 6) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
597 Probably needs a bit of work. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
598 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
599 List of encoding aliases. (Takao Fujiware, 2009 Jul 18) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
600 Are they all OK? Update Jul 22. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
601 |
2581 | 602 Win32: Improved Makefile for MSVC. (Leonardo Valeri Manera, 2010 Aug 18) |
603 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
604 Win32: Expanding 'path' runs into a maximum size limit. (bgold12, 2009 Nov 15) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
605 |
2581 | 606 Win32: Patch for enabling quick edit mode in console. (Craig Barkhouse, 2010 |
607 Sep 1) | |
608 | |
3356 | 609 Win32: Patch for using .png files for icons. (Charles Peacech, 2012 Feb 5) |
610 | |
2502
e6420d275b6a
Update README files. Remove references to extra and lang archives.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2495
diff
changeset
|
611 Putting a Visual block while 'visualedit' is "all" does not leave the cursor |
e6420d275b6a
Update README files. Remove references to extra and lang archives.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2495
diff
changeset
|
612 on the first character. (John Beckett, 2010 Aug 7) |
e6420d275b6a
Update README files. Remove references to extra and lang archives.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2495
diff
changeset
|
613 |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
614 Setting 'tags' to "tagsdir/*" does not find "tagsdir/tags". (Steven K. Wong, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
615 2009 Jul 18) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
616 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
617 Patch to add farsi handling to arabic.c (Ali Gholami Rudi, 2009 May 2) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
618 Added test, updates, June 23. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
619 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
620 Patch to add "focusonly" to 'scrollopt', so that scrollbind also applies in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
621 window that doesn't have focus. (Jonathon Mah, 2009 Jan 12) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
622 Needs more work. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
623 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
624 Problem with <script> mappings (Andy Wokula, 2009 Mar 8) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
625 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
626 When starting Vim with "gvim -f -u non_existent_file > foo.txt" there are a |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
627 few control characters in the output. (Dale Wiles, 2009 May 28) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
628 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
629 'cmdwinheight is only used in last window when 'winheight' is a large value. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
630 (Tony Mechelynck, 2009 Apr 15) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
631 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
632 Status line containing winnr() isn't updated when splitting the window (Clark |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
633 J. Wang, 2009 Mar 31) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
634 |
2152 | 635 When $VIMRUNTIME is set in .vimrc, need to reload lang files. Already done |
636 for GTK, how about others? (Ron Aaron, 2010 Apr 10) | |
637 | |
2540 | 638 Patch for GTK buttons X1Mouse and X2Mouse. (Christian J. Robinson, 2010 Aug 9) |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
639 |
2152 | 640 Motif: Build on Ubuntu can't enter any text in dialog text fields. |
641 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
642 When 'ft' changes redraw custom status line. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
643 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
644 ":tab split fname" doesn't set the alternate file in the original window, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
645 because win_valid() always returns FALSE. Below win_new_tabpage() in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
646 ex_docmd.c. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
647 |
2152 | 648 Space before comma in function definition not allowed: "function x(a , b)" |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
649 Give a more appropriate error message. Add a remark to the docs. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
650 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
651 string_convert() should be able to convert between utf-8 and utf-16le. Used |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
652 for GTK clipboard. Avoid requirement for iconv. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
653 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
654 Now that colnr_T is int instead of unsigned, more type casts can be removed. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
655 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
656 'delcombine' does not work for the command line. (Tony Mechelynck, 2009 Jul |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
657 20) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
658 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
659 Unwanted file name escaping: ":echo input('file:' , '', 'file')" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
660 And use file name completion on a file with spaces. (Frederic Hardy, 2009 Mar |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
661 23) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
662 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
663 Don't load macmap.vim on startup, turn it into a plugin. (Ron Aaron, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
664 2009 Apr 7) Reminder Apr 14. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
665 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
666 Add "no_hlsearch" to winsaveview(). |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
667 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
668 Cursorline highlighting combines with Search ('hlsearch') but not with |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
669 SpellBad. (Jim Karsten, 2009 Mar 18) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
670 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
671 When 'foldmethod' is "indent", using >> on a line just above a fold makes the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
672 cursor line folded. (Evan Laforge, 2009 Oct 17) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
673 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
674 When 'foldmethod' is "indent", adding an empty line below a fold and then |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
675 indented text, creates a new fold instead of joining it with the previous one. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
676 (Evan Laforge, 2009 Oct 17) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
677 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
678 Bug: When reloading a buffer changed outside of Vim, BufRead autocommands |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
679 are applied to the wrong buffer/window. (Ben Fritz, 2009 Apr 2, May 11) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
680 Ignore window options when not in the right window? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
681 Perhaps we need to use a hidden window for applying autocommands to a buffer |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
682 that doesn't have a window. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
683 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
684 When using "ab foo bar" and mapping <Tab> to <Esc>, pressing <Tab> after foo |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
685 doesn't trigger the abbreviation like <Esc> would. (Ramana Kumar, 2009 Sep 6) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
686 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
687 getbufvar() to get a window-local option value for a buffer that's not |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
688 displayed in a window should return the value that's stored for that buffer. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
689 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
690 ":he ctrl_u" can be auto-corrected to ":he ctrl-u". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
691 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
692 There should be a way after an abbreviation has expanded to go back to what |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
693 was typed. CTRL-G h ? Would also undo last word or line break inserted |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
694 perhaps. And undo CTRL-W. CTRL-G l would redo. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
695 |
2495
a847363bf06e
Fix a few problems for :find completion. Test much more. (Nazri Ramliy)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2493
diff
changeset
|
696 Diff mode out of sync. (Gary Johnson, 2010 Aug 4) |
a847363bf06e
Fix a few problems for :find completion. Test much more. (Nazri Ramliy)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2493
diff
changeset
|
697 |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
698 Support a 'systemencoding' option (for Unix). It specifies the encoding of |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
699 file names. (Kikuchan, 2010 Oct 5). Useful on a latin1 or double-byte Asian |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
700 system when 'encoding' is "utf-8". |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2596
diff
changeset
|
701 |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
702 Win32: A --remote command that has a directory name starting with a ( doesn't |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
703 work, the backslash is removed, assuming that it escapes the (. (Valery |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
704 Kondakoff, 2009 May 13) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
705 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
706 Win32 GUI: Changing manifest helps for dpi changes (Joe Castro, 2009 Mar 27) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
707 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
708 Win32 GUI: last message from startup doesn't show up when there is an echoerr |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
709 command. (Cyril Slobin, 2009 Mar 13) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
710 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
711 Win32: use different args for SearchPath()? (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2009 Jan 30) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
712 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
713 Win32: completion of file name ":e c:\!test" results in ":e c:\\!test", which |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
714 does not work. (Nieko Maatjes, 2009 Jan 8, Ingo Karkat, 2009 Jan 22) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
715 |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2373
diff
changeset
|
716 opening/closing window causes other window with 'winfixheight' to change |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2373
diff
changeset
|
717 height. Also happens when there is another window in the frame, if it's not |
2391
f1d95a986dfb
Document extra argument for Python append().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2389
diff
changeset
|
718 very high. (Yegappan Lakshmanan, 2010 Jul 22, Michael Peeters, 2010 Jul 22) |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2373
diff
changeset
|
719 |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
720 Directory wrong in session file, caused by ":lcd" in BufEnter autocommand. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
721 (Felix Kater, 2009 Mar 3) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
722 |
2662 | 723 Session file generates error upon loading, cause bu --remote-silent-tab. |
724 (7tommm (ytommm) 2010 Nov 24) | |
725 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
726 Using ~ works OK on 'a' with composing char, but not on 0x0418 with composing |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
727 char 0x0301. (Tony Mechelynck, 2009 Mar 4) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
728 |
2681 | 729 A function on a dictionary is not profiled. (Zyx, 2010 Dec 25) |
730 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
731 Inconsistent: starting with $LANG set to es_ES.utf-8 gives Spanish |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
732 messages, even though locale is not supported. But ":lang messages |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
733 es_ES.utf-8" gives an error and doesn't switch messages. (Dominique Pelle, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
734 2009 Jan 26) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
735 |
2681 | 736 When $HOME contains special characters, such as a comma, escape them when used |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
737 in an option. (Michael Hordijk, 2009 May 5) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
738 Turn "esc" argument of expand_env_esc() into string of chars to be escaped. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
739 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
740 Should make 'ignorecase' global-local, so that it makes sense setting it from |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
741 a modeline. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
742 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
743 Add cscope target to Makefile. (Tony Mechelynck, 2009 Jun 18, replies by |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
744 Sergey Khorev) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
745 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
746 Consider making YankRing or something else that keeps a list of yanked text |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
747 part of standard Vim. The "1 to "9 registers are not sufficient. |
1624 | 748 |
1698 | 749 netrw: dragging status line causes selection of entry. Should check row |
750 number to be below last visible line. | |
751 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
752 After doing "su" $HOME can be the old user's home, thus ~root/file is not |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
753 correct. Don't use it in the swap file. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
754 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
755 Completion for ":buf" doesn't work properly on Win32 when 'shellslash' is off. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
756 (Henrik Ohman, 2009, Jan 29) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
757 |
2642 | 758 shellescape() depends on 'shellshash' for quoting. That doesn't work when |
759 'shellslash' is set but using cmd.exe. (Ben Fritz) | |
760 Use a different option or let it depend on whether 'shell' looks like a | |
761 unix-like shell? | |
762 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
763 Allow patches to add something to version.c, like with an official patch, so |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
764 that :version output shows which patches have been applied. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
765 |
2152 | 766 Bug: in Ex mode (after "Q") backslash before line break, when yanked into a |
767 register and executed, results in <Nul>: instead of line break. | |
768 (Konrad Schwarz, 2010 Apr 16) | |
769 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
770 Have a look at patch for utf-8 line breaking. (Yongwei Wu, 2008 Mar 1, Mar 23) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
771 Now at: http://vimgadgets.sourceforge.net/liblinebreak/ |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
772 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
773 Greek sigma character should be lower cased depending on the context. Can we |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
774 make this work? (Dominique Pelle, 2009 Sep 24) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
775 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
776 When changing 'encoding' convert all the swap file names, so that we can |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
777 still delete them. Also convert all buffer file names? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
778 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
779 "gqip" in Insert mode has an off-by-one error, causing it to reflow text. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
780 (Raul Coronado, 2009 Nov 2) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
781 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
782 Update src/testdir/main.aap. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
783 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
784 "vim -c 'sniff connect'" hangs Vim. (Dominique Pelle, 2008 Dec 7) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
785 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
786 Something wrong with session that has "cd" commands and "badd", in such a way |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
787 that Vim doesn't find the edited file in the buffer list, causing the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
788 ATTENTION message? (Tony Mechelynck, 2008 Dec 1) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
789 Also: swap files are in ~/tmp/ One has relative file name ".mozilla/...". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
790 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
791 Add v:motion_force. (Kana Natsuno, 2008 Dec 6) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
792 |
1668 | 793 Runtime files for Clojure. (Toralf Wittner, 2008 Jun 25) |
794 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
795 MS-Windows: editing the first, empty buffer, 'ffs' set to "unix,dos", ":enew" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
796 doesn't set 'ff' to "unix". (Ben Fritz, 2008 Dec 5) Reusing the old buffer |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
797 probably causes this. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
798 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
799 'scrollbind' is not respected when deleting lines or undo. (Milan Vancura, |
2190 | 800 2009 Jan 16) |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
801 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
802 Document that default font in Athena can be set with resources: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
803 XtDefaultFont: "9x15" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
804 XtDefaultFontSet: "9x15" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
805 (Richard Sherman, 2009 Apr 12) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
806 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
807 Having "Syntax" in 'eventignore' for :bufdo may cause problems, e.g. for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
808 ":bufdo e" when buffers are open in windows. ex_listdo(eap) could set the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
809 option only for when jumping to another buffer, not when the command argument |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
810 is executed. |
1668 | 811 |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
812 ":pedit %" with a BufReadPre autocommand causes the cursor to move to the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
813 first line. (Ingo Karkat, 2008 Jul 1) Ian Kelling is working on this. |
1624 | 814 |
815 Wildmenu not deleted: "gvim -u NONE", ":set nocp wildmenu cmdheight=3 | |
816 laststatus=2", CTRL-D CTRL-H CTRL-H CTRL-H. (A.Politz, 2008 April 1) | |
817 Works OK with Vim in an xterm. | |
818 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
819 Cursor line moves in other window when using CTRL-W J that doesn't change |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
820 anything. (Dasn, 2009 Apr 7) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
821 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
822 On Unix "glob('does not exist~')" returns the string. Without the "~" it |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
823 doesn't. (John Little, 2008 Nov 9) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
824 Shell expansion returns unexpanded string? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
825 Don't use shell when "~" is not at the start? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
826 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
827 ":unlet $VAR" doesn't work. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
828 |
1698 | 829 When using ":e ++enc=foo file" and the file is already loaded with |
830 'fileencoding' set to "bar", then do_ecmd() uses that buffer, even though the | |
831 fileencoding differs. Reload the buffer in this situation? Need to check for | |
832 the buffer to be unmodified. | |
833 Unfinished patch by Ian Kelling, 2008 Jul 11. Followup Jul 14, need to have | |
834 another look at it. | |
835 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
836 c.vim: XXX in a comment is colored yellow, but not when it's after "#if 0". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
837 (Ilya Dogolazky, 2009 Aug 7) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
838 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
839 You can type ":w ++bad=x fname", but the ++bad argument is ignored. Give an |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
840 error message? Or is this easy to implement? (Nathan Stratton Treadway, 2008 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
841 Aug 20) This is in ucs2bytes(), search for 0xBF. Using the ++bad argument is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
842 at the other match for 0xBF. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
843 |
1624 | 844 Fix for matchparen HL doesn't work. beep. |
845 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
846 When adding "-complete=file" to a user command this also changes how the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
847 argument is processed for <f-args>. (Ivan Tishchenko, 2008 Aug 19) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
848 |
1624 | 849 Win32: associating a type with Vim doesn't take care of space after a |
850 backslash? (Robert Vibrant, 2008 Jun 5) | |
851 | |
2581 | 852 Win32: bold font doesn't work when 'guifontwide' has been set. (Yue Wu, 2010 |
853 Aug 23) | |
854 | |
855 When 'rightleft' is set, cursorcolumn isn't highlighted after the end of a | |
856 line. It's also wrong in folds. (Dominique Pelle, 2010 Aug 21) | |
857 | |
858 Using an insert mode expression mapping, cursor is not in the expected | |
859 position. (ZyX, 2010 Aug 29) | |
860 | |
1624 | 861 After using <Tab> for command line completion after ":ta blah" and getting E33 |
862 (no tags file), further editing the command to e.g., ":echo 'blah'", the | |
1698 | 863 command is not executed. Fix by Ian Kelling? |
1624 | 864 |
1698 | 865 ":help s/~" jumps to *s/\~*, while ":help s/\~" doesn't find anything. (Tim |
866 Chase) Fix by Ian Kelling, 2008 Jul 14. | |
867 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
868 Use "\U12345678" for 32 bit Unicode characters? (Tony Mechelynck, 2009 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
869 Apr 6) Or use "\u(123456)", similar to Perl. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
870 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
871 When mapping : to ; and ; to :, @; doesn't work like @: and @: doesn't work |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
872 either. Matt Wozniski: nv_at() calls do_execreg() which uses |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
873 put_in_typebuf(). Char mapped twice? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
874 |
1624 | 875 Despite adding save_subexpr() this still doesn't work properly: |
876 Regexp: matchlist('12a4aaa', '^\(.\{-}\)\(\%5c\@<=a\+\)\(.\+\)\?') | |
877 Returns ['12a4', 'aaa', '4aaa'], should be ['12a4', 'aaa', ''] | |
878 Backreference not cleared when retrying after \@<= fails? | |
879 (Brett Stahlman, 2008 March 8) | |
880 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
881 Problem with remote_send(). (Charles Campbell, 2008 Aug 12) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
882 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
883 ftplugin for help file should set 'isk' to help file value. |
1698 | 884 |
1624 | 885 Win32: remote editing fails when the current directory name contains "[". |
886 (Ivan Tishchenko, Liu Yubao) Suggested patch by Chris Lubinski: Avoid | |
887 escaping characters where the backslash is not removed later. Asked Chris for | |
888 an alternate solution, also for src/ex_getln.c. | |
1668 | 889 This also fails when the file or directory name contains "%". (Thoml, 2008 |
890 July 7) | |
1624 | 891 |
892 Problem with 'langmap' being used on the rhs of a mapping. (Nikolai Weibull, | |
893 2008 May 14) | |
894 | |
895 Problem with CTRL-F. (Charles Campbell, 2008 March 21) | |
896 Only happens with "gvim -geometry "160x26+4+27" -u NONE -U NONE prop.c". | |
897 'lines' is 54. (2008 March 27) | |
898 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
899 Problem with pointer wrapping around in getvcol(). (Wolfgang Kroworsch, 2008 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
900 Oct 19) Check for "col" being "MAXCOL" separately? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
901 |
1624 | 902 Unexpectedly inserting a double quote. (Anton Woellert, 2008 Mar 23) |
903 Works OK when 'cmdheight' is 2. | |
904 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
905 Test54 should not use shell commands. Make it portable. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
906 |
1624 | 907 The utf class table is missing some entries: |
908 0x2212, minus sign | |
909 0x2217, star | |
910 0x2500, bar | |
911 0x26ab, circle | |
912 | |
913 Visual line mode doesn't highlight properly when 'showbreak' is used and the | |
914 line doesn't fit. (Dasn, 2008 May 1) | |
915 | |
916 GUI: In Normal mode can't yank the modeless selection. Make "gy" do this? | |
917 Works like CTRL-Y in Command line mode. | |
918 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
919 Mac: Move Carbon todo items to os_mac.txt. Note that this version is frozen, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
920 try the Cocoa version. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
921 |
1125 | 922 Mac: After a ":vsplit" the left scrollbar doesn't appear until 'columns' is |
923 changed or the window is resized. | |
924 | |
2662 | 925 GTK: when setting 'columns' in a startup script and doing ":vertical diffsplit" |
926 the window isn't redrawn properly, see two vertical bars. | |
927 | |
1624 | 928 Mac: Patch for configure: remove arch from ruby link args. (Knezevic, 2008 |
929 Mar 5) Alternative: Kazuki Sakamoto, Mar 7. | |
930 | |
1698 | 931 Mac: trouble compiling with Motif, requires --disable-darwin. (Raf, 2008 Aug |
932 1) Reply by Ben Schmidt. | |
933 | |
1624 | 934 C't: On utf-8 system, editing file with umlaut through Gnome results in URL |
935 with %nn%nn, which is taken as two characters instead of one. | |
936 Try to reproduce at work. | |
937 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
938 Patch for default choice in file changed dialog. (Bjorn Winckler, 2008 Oct 19) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
939 Is there a way to list all the files first? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
940 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
941 When 'smartcase' is set and using CTRL-L to add to the search pattern it may |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
942 result in no matches. Convert chars to lower case? (Erik Wognsen, 2009 Apr |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
943 16) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
944 |
2581 | 945 Searching for composing char works, but not when inside []. (ZyX, Benjamin R. |
946 Haskell, 2010 Aug 24) | |
947 | |
948 Fail to edit file after failed register access. Error flag remains set? | |
949 (Lech Lorens, 2010 Aug 30) | |
950 | |
1624 | 951 Patch for redo register. (Ben Schmidt, 2007 Oct 19) |
952 Await response to question to make the register writable. | |
953 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
954 src/testdir/Make_dos.mak: not all tests are included, e.g., test49, without a |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
955 remark why. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
956 |
1624 | 957 Problem with 'ts' set to 9 and 'showbreak' to ">>>". (Matthew Winn, 2007 Oct |
958 1) | |
959 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
960 In the swapfile dialog, add a H(elp) option that gives more info about what |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
961 each choice does. Similar to ":help swap-exists-choices" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
962 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
963 try/catch not working for argument of return. (Matt Wozniski, 2008 Sep 15) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
964 |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
965 try/catch not working when inside a for loop. (ZyX, 2011 Jan 25) |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
966 |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
967 ":tab help" always opens a new tab, while ":help" re-uses an existing window. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
968 Would be more consistent when an existing tab is re-used. (Tony Mechelynck) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
969 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
970 Add ":nofold". Range will apply without expanding to closed fold. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
971 |
1624 | 972 Including NFA regexp code: |
973 Use "\%#= to set the engine: 0 = automatic, 1 = backtracking, 2 = new. | |
974 Useful in tests. | |
975 Performance tests: | |
976 - ~/vim/test/veryslow.js (file from Daniel Fetchinson) | |
977 - ~/vim/test/slowsearch | |
978 - ~/vim/test/rgb.vim | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
979 - ~/vim/text/FeiqCfg.xml (file from Netjune) |
3371 | 980 - ~/vim/text/edl.svg (also XML) |
1624 | 981 - search for a.*e*exn in the vim executable. Go to last line to use |
982 'hlsearch'. | |
1125 | 983 |
984 Using Aap to build Vim: add remarks about how to set personal preferences. | |
985 Example on http://www.calmar.ws/tmp/aap.html | |
986 | |
1624 | 987 Syntax highlighting wrong for transparent region. (Doug Kearns, 2007 Feb 26) |
988 Bug in using a transparent syntax region. (Hanlen in vim-dev maillist, 2007 | |
989 Jul 31) | |
1125 | 990 |
991 C syntax: {} inside () causes following {} to be highlighted as error. | |
992 (Michalis Giannakidis, 2006 Jun 1) | |
993 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
994 Can't easily close the help window, like ":pc" closes the preview window and |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
995 ":ccl" closes the quickfix window. Add ":hclose". (Chris Gaal) |
2581 | 996 Patch for :helpclose, Christian Brabandt, 2010 Sep 6. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
997 |
1624 | 998 When 'diffopt' has "context:0" a single deleted line causes two folds to merge |
999 and mess up syncing. (Austin Jennings, 2008 Jan 31) | |
1000 | |
1125 | 1001 Gnome improvements: Edward Catmur, 2007 Jan 7 |
1002 Also use Save/Discard for other GUIs | |
1003 | |
1004 New PHP syntax file, use it? (Peter Hodge) | |
1005 | |
2908 | 1006 ":echoe" in catch block stops processing, while this doesn't happen outside of |
1007 a catch block. (ZyX, 2011 Jun 2) | |
1008 | |
1125 | 1009 'foldcolumn' in modeline applied to wrong window when using a session. (Teemu |
1010 Likonen, March 19) | |
1011 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1012 Test 54 uses shell commands, that doesn't work on non-Unix systems. Use some |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1013 other way to test buffer-local autocommands. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1014 |
1698 | 1015 The documentation mentions the priority for ":2match" and ":3match", but it |
1016 appears the last one wins. (John Beckett, 2008 Jul 22) Caused by adding | |
1017 matchadd()? Suggested patch by John, 2008 Jul 24. | |
1018 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1019 When 'encoding' is utf-8 the command line is redrawn as a whole on every |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1020 character typed. (Tyler Spivey, 2008 Sep 3) Only redraw cmdline for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1021 'arabicshape' when there is a character on the command line for which |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1022 (ARABIC_CHAR(u8c)) is TRUE. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1023 |
1624 | 1024 Cheng Fang made javacomplete. (2007 Aug 11) |
1025 Asked about latest version: 0.77.1 is on www.vim.org. | |
1125 | 1026 |
1027 More AmigaOS4 patches. (Peter Bengtsson, Nov 9) | |
1028 | |
2581 | 1029 Amiga patches with vbcc. (Adrien Destugues, 2010 Aug 30) |
1030 http://pulkomandy.ath.cx/drop/vim73_vbcc_amiga.diff | |
1031 | |
1698 | 1032 Insert mode completion: When editing the text and pressing CTRL-N again goes |
1033 back to originally completed text, edited text is gone. (Peng Yu, 2008 Jul 24) | |
1034 Suggestion by Ben Schmidt, 2008 Aug 6. | |
1624 | 1035 |
1036 Problem with compound words? (Bert, 2008 May 6) | |
1037 No warning for when flags are defined after they are used in an affix. | |
1038 | |
1039 Screen redrawing when continuously updating the buffer and resizing the | |
1040 terminal. (Yakov Lerner, 2006 Sept 7) | |
1125 | 1041 |
1042 Add option settings to help ftplugin. (David Eggum, 2006 Dec 18) | |
1043 | |
1624 | 1044 Autoconf problem: when checking for iconv library we may add -L/usr/local/lib, |
1045 but when compiling further tests -liconv is added without the -L argument, | |
1046 that may fail (e.g., sizeof(int)). (Blaine, 2007 Aug 21) | |
1125 | 1047 |
1048 When opening quickfix window, disable spell checking? | |
1049 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1050 Problem with ".add" files when using two languages and restarting Vim. (Raul |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1051 Coronado, 2008 Oct 30) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1052 |
1624 | 1053 Popup menu redraw: Instead of first redrawing the text and then drawing the |
1054 popup menu over it, first draw the new popup menu, remember its position and | |
1055 size and then redraw the text, skipping the characters under the popup menu. | |
1056 This should avoid flicker. Other solution by A.Politz, 2007 Aug 22. | |
1057 | |
1226 | 1058 Windows 98: pasting from the clipboard with text from another application has |
1059 a trailing NUL. (Joachim Hofmann) Perhaps the length specified for CF_TEXT | |
1060 isn't right? | |
1061 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1062 When a register contains illegal bytes, writing viminfo in utf-8 and reading |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1063 it back doesn't result in utf-8. (Devin Bayer) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1064 |
1698 | 1065 Command line completion: Scanning for tags doesn't check for typed key now and |
1066 then? Hangs for about 5 seconds. Appears to be caused by finding include | |
1067 files with "foo/**" in 'path'. (Kalisiak, 2006 July 15) | |
1668 | 1068 Additional info: When using the |wildcards| ** globing, vim hangs |
1069 indefinitely on lots of directories. The |file-searching| globing, like in | |
1070 ":set path=/**" does not hang as often as with globing with |wildcards|, like | |
1071 in ":1find /**/file". This is for a files that unix "find" can find very | |
1072 quick. Merging the 2 kinds of globing might make this an easier fix. (Ian | |
1073 Kelling, 2008 July 4) | |
1125 | 1074 |
1624 | 1075 When the file name has parenthesis, e.g., "foo (bar).txt", ":!ls '%'" has the |
1076 parenthesis escaped but not the space. That's inconsistent. Either escape | |
1077 neither or both. No escaping might be best, because it doesn't depend on | |
1078 particularities of the shell. (Zvi Har'El, 2007 Nov 10) (Teemu Likonen, 2008 | |
1079 Jun 3) | |
1080 However, for backwards compatibility escaping might be necessary. Check if | |
1081 the user put quotes around the expanded item? | |
1125 | 1082 |
2833 | 1083 A throw in a function causes missing an endif below the call. (Spiros |
1084 Bousbouras, 2011 May 16) | |
1085 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1086 Error E324 can be given when a cron script has wiped out our temp directory. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1087 Give a clear error message about this (and tell them not to wipe out /tmp). |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1088 |
1125 | 1089 Color for cUserLabel should differ from case label, so that a mistake in a |
1090 switch list is noticed: | |
1091 switch (i) | |
1092 { | |
1093 case 1: | |
1094 foobar: | |
1095 } | |
1096 | |
1097 Look at http://www.gtk-server.org/ . It has a Vim script implementation. | |
1098 | |
1624 | 1099 Netbeans problem. Use "nc -l 127.0.0.1 55555" for the server, then run gvim |
1100 with "gvim -nb:localhost:55555:foo". From nc do: '1:editFile!0 "foo"'. Then | |
1101 go to Insert mode and add a few lines. Then backspacing every other time | |
1102 moves the cursor instead of deleting. (Chris Kaiser, 2007 Sep 25) | |
1103 | |
2439 | 1104 Patch to use Modern UI 2.0 for the Nsis installer. (Guopeng Wen, 2010 Jul 30) |
2833 | 1105 Latest version: 2011 May 18 |
2681 | 1106 8 Windows install with NSIS: make it possible to do a silent install, see |
1107 http://nsis.sourceforge.net/Docs/Chapter4.html#4.12 | |
1108 Version from Guopeng Wen that does this (2010 Dec 27) | |
2439 | 1109 |
3237 | 1110 Windows installer should install 32-bit version of right-click handler also on |
1111 64-bit systems. (Brian Cunningham, 2011 Dec 28) | |
1112 | |
1113 Windows installer could add a "open in new tab of existing Vim" menu entry. | |
1114 Gvimext: patch to add "Edit with single Vim &tabbed" menu entry. | |
1115 Just have two choices, always using one Vim and selecting between using an | |
1116 argument list or opening each file in a separate tab. | |
1117 (Erik Falor, 2008 May 21, 2008 Jun 26) | |
1118 | |
2833 | 1119 Windows installer: licence text should not use indent, causes bad word wrap. |
1120 (Benjamin Fritz, 2010 Aug 16) | |
1121 | |
1122 Dos uninstal may delete vim.bat from the wrong directory (e.g., when someone | |
1123 makes his own wrapper). Add a magic string with the version number to the | |
1124 .bat file and check for it in the uninstaller. E.g. | |
1125 # uninstall key: vim7.3* | |
1126 | |
1125 | 1127 Changes for Win32 makefile. (Mike Williams, 2007 Jan 22, Alexei Alexandrov, |
1128 2007 Feb 8) | |
1129 | |
1130 Patch for Win32 clipboard under Cygwin. (Frodak Baksik, Feb 15) | |
1131 Sutcliffe says it works well. | |
1624 | 1132 Update 2007 May 22 for Vim 7.1 |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1133 Update 2008 Dec 2008 for Vim 7.2.xx (Sharonov) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1134 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1135 Win32: Can't complete shell command names. Why is setting xp_context in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1136 set_one_cmd_context() inside #ifndef BACKSLASH_IN_FILENAME? |
1125 | 1137 |
1138 Win32: Patch for convert_filterW(). (Taro Muraoka, 2007 Mar 2) | |
1139 | |
1624 | 1140 Win32: Patch for cscope external command. (Mike Williams, 2007 Aug 7) |
1141 | |
1125 | 1142 Win32: XPM support only works with path without spaces. Patch by Mathias |
1143 Michaelis, 2006 Jun 9. Another patch for more path names, 2006 May 31. | |
1144 New version: http://members.tcnet.ch/michaelis/vim/patches.zip (also for other | |
1145 patches by Mathias, see mail Feb 22) | |
1146 | |
1147 Win32: compiling with normal features and OLE fails. Patch by Mathias | |
1148 Michaelis, 2006 Jun 4. | |
1149 | |
1150 Win32: echo doesn't work for gvim.exe.mnf. Use inline file. Patch by Mathias | |
1151 Michaelis. http://groups.yahoo.com/group/vimdev/message/43765 | |
1152 Patch that includes this and does more by George Reilly, 2007 Feb 12 | |
1153 | |
1154 Win16: include patches to make Win16 version work. (Vince Negri, 2006 May 22) | |
1155 | |
1156 Win32: after "[I" showing matches, scroll wheel messes up screen. (Tsakiridis, | |
1157 2007 Feb 18) | |
1624 | 1158 Patch by Alex Dobrynin, 2007 Jun 3. Also fixes other scroll wheel problems. |
1125 | 1159 |
1160 Win32: using CTRL-S in Insert mode doesn't remove the "+" from the tab pages | |
1702 | 1161 label. (Tsakiridis, 2007 Feb 18) Patch from Ian Kelling, 2008 Aug 6. |
1162 | |
1624 | 1163 Win32: using "gvim --remote-tab-silent fname" sometimes gives an empty screen |
1164 with the more prompt. Caused by setting the guitablabel? (Thomas Michael | |
1165 Engelke, 2007 Dec 20 - 2008 Jan 17) | |
1125 | 1166 |
1167 Win64: Seek error in swap file for a very big file (3 Gbyte). Check storing | |
1168 pointer in long and seek offset in 64 bit var. | |
1169 | |
1624 | 1170 Win32: patch for fullscreen mode. (Liushaolin, 2008 April 17) |
1171 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1172 Win32: When there is 4 Gbyte of memory mch_avail_mem() doesn't work properly. |
2174
755eb92c5961
Move items around in the todo list.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1173 Unfinished patch by Jelle Geerts, 2008 Aug 24. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1174 Let mch_avail_mem() return Kbyte instead? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1175 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1176 Win32: When 'shell' is bash shellescape() doesn't always do the right thing. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1177 Depends on 'shellslash', 'shellquote' and 'shellxquote', but shellescape() |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1178 only takes 'shellslash' into account. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1179 |
1624 | 1180 Pressing the 'pastetoggle' key doesn't update the statusline. (Jan Christoph |
1181 Ebersbach, 2008 Feb 1) | |
1182 | |
1183 Menu item that does "xxd -r" doesn't work when 'fileencoding' is utf-16. | |
1184 Check for this and use iconv? (Edward L. Fox, 2007 Sep 12) | |
1185 Does the conversion in the other direction work when 'filenecodings' is set | |
1186 properly? | |
1187 | |
1188 Cursor displayed in the wrong position when using 'numberwidth'. (James Vega, | |
1189 2007 Jun 21) | |
1190 | |
1191 When $VAR contains a backslash expand('$VAR') removes it. (Teemu Likonen, 2008 | |
1192 Jun 18) | |
1193 | |
1194 If the variable "g:x#y#z" exists completion after ":echo g:x#" doesn't work. | |
1195 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1196 Feature request: Command to go to previous tab, like what CTRL-W p does for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1197 windows. (Adam George) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1198 |
1624 | 1199 F1 - F4 in an xterm produce a different escape sequence when used with a |
1200 modifier key. Need to catch three different sequences. Use K_ZF1, like | |
1201 K_ZHOME? (Dickey, 2007 Dec 2) | |
1125 | 1202 |
1203 UTF-8: mapping a multi-byte key where the second byte is 0x80 doesn't appear | |
1204 to work. (Tony Mechelynck, 2007 March 2) | |
1205 | |
1206 In debug mode, using CTRL-R = to evaluate a function causes stepping through | |
1207 the function. (Hari Krishna Dara, 2006 Jun 28) | |
1208 | |
1209 C++ indenting wrong with "=". (James Kanze, 2007 Jan 26) | |
1210 | |
1211 ":lockvar" should use copyID to avoid endless loop. | |
1212 | |
1624 | 1213 When using --remote-silent and the file name matches 'wildignore' get an E479 |
1668 | 1214 error. without --remote-silent it works fine. (Ben Fritz, 2008 Jun 20) |
1226 | 1215 |
1125 | 1216 Gvim: dialog for closing Vim should check if Vim is busy writing a file. Then |
1217 use a different dialog: "busy saving, really quit? yes / no". | |
1218 | |
1219 Check other interfaces for changing curbuf in a wrong way. Patch like for | |
1220 if_ruby.c. | |
1221 | |
1222 ":helpgrep" should use the directory from 'helpfile'. | |
1223 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1224 Patch to dynamically load Python on Solaris. (Danek Duvall, 2009 Feb 16) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1225 Needs more work. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1226 |
1125 | 1227 The need_fileinfo flag is messy. Instead make the message right away and put |
1228 it in keep_msg? | |
1229 | |
1230 Editing a file remotely that matches 'wildignore' results in a "no match" | |
2174
755eb92c5961
Move items around in the todo list.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1231 error. Should only happen when there are wildcards, not when giving the file |
1125 | 1232 name literally, and esp. if there is only one name. |
1233 | |
874 | 1234 Test 61 fails sometimes. This is a timing problem: "sleep 2" sometimes takes |
1235 longer than 2 seconds. | |
857 | 1236 |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1237 Using ":au CursorMoved * cmd" invokes mch_FullName(), which can be slow. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1238 Can this be avoided? (Thomas Waba, 2008 Aug 24) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1239 Also for ":w" without a file name. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1240 The buffer has the full path in ffname, should pass this to the autocommand. |
1624 | 1241 |
1242 "vim -C" often has 'nocompatible', because it's set in some startup script. | |
1243 Set 'compatible' after startup is done? Patch by James Vega, 2008 Feb 7. | |
1244 | |
1125 | 1245 VMS: while editing a file found in complex, Vim will save file into the first |
1246 directory of the path and not to the original location of the file. | |
1247 (Zoltan Arpadffy) | |
1248 | |
1624 | 1249 VMS: VFC files are in some cases truncated during reading (Zoltan Arpadffy) |
1250 | |
1125 | 1251 input() completion should not insert a backslash to escape a space in a file |
1252 name? | |
1253 | |
1254 Ruby completion is insecure. Can this be fixed? | |
1255 | |
1256 When 'backupskip' is set from $TEMP special characters need to be escaped. | |
1257 (patch by Grembowietz, 2007 Feb 26, not quite right) | |
1258 Another problem is that file_pat_to_reg_pat() doesn't recognize "\\", so "\\(" | |
1259 will be seen as a path separator plus "\(". | |
1260 | |
2072 | 1261 gvim d:\path\path\(FILE).xml should not remove the \ before the (. |
1262 This also fails with --remote. | |
1263 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1264 When doing ":quit" the Netbeans "killed" event isn't sent. (Xavier de Gaye, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1265 2008 Nov 10) call netbeans_file_closed() at the end of buf_freeall(), or in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1266 all places where buf_freeall() is called? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1267 |
1125 | 1268 ":python os.chdir('/tmp')" makes short buffer names invalid. (Xavier de Gaye) |
1269 Check directory and call shorten_fnames()? | |
1270 | |
1271 aucmd_prepbuf() should also use a window in another tab page. | |
1272 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1273 When unloading a buffer in a BufHidden autocommand the hidden flag is reset? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1274 (Bob Hiestand, 2008 Aug 26, Aug 27) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1275 |
1125 | 1276 Substituting an area with a line break with almost the same area does change |
1277 the Visual area. Can this be fixed? (James Vega, 2006 Sept 15) | |
1278 | |
1279 GUI: When combining fg en bg make sure they are not equal. | |
1280 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1281 Spell checking: Add a way to specify punctuation characters. Add the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1282 superscript numbers by default: 0x2070, 0xb9, 0xb2, 0xb3, 0x2074 - 0x2079. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1283 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1284 Spell checking in popup menu: If the only problem is the case of the first |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1285 character, don't offer "ignore" and "add to word list". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1286 |
1125 | 1287 Use different pt_br dictionary for spell checking. (Jackson A. Aquino, 2006 |
1288 Jun 5) | |
1289 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1290 Use different romanian dictionary for spell checking. (Andrei Popescu, Nov |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1291 2008) Use http://downloads.sourceforge.net/rospell/ro_RO.3.2.zip |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1292 Or the hunspell-ro.3.2.tar.gz file, it also has a iso-8859-2 list. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1293 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1294 In a C file with spell checking, in "% integer" "nteger" is seen as an error, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1295 but "]s" doesn't find it. "nteger" by itself is found. (Ralf Wildenhues, 2008 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1296 Jul 22) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1297 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1298 There should be something about spell checking in the user manual. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1299 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1300 Spell menu: When using the Popup menu to select a replacement word, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1301 ":spellrepeat" doesn't work. SpellReplace() uses setline(). Can it use "z=" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1302 somehow? Or use a new function. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1303 |
1125 | 1304 Mac: Using gvim: netrw window disappears. (Nick Lo, 2006 Jun 21) |
1305 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1306 Mac: OS/X 10.4 with Python 2.5 installed: configure finds an extra argument |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1307 that breaks the build. (Brian Victor, 2008 Sep 1) |
1698 | 1308 |
1125 | 1309 Add an option to specify the character to use when a double-width character is |
1310 moved to the next line. Default '>', set to a space to blank it out. Check | |
1311 that char is single width when it's set (compare with 'listchars'). | |
1312 | |
1313 The generated vim.bat can avoid the loop for NT. (Carl Zmola, 2006 Sep 3) | |
1314 | |
1315 Session file creation: 'autochdir' causes trouble. Keep it off until after | |
1316 loading all files. | |
1317 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1318 Win32: When 'autochdir' is on and 'encoding' is changed, files on the command |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1319 line are opened again, but from the wrong directory. Apply 'autochdir' only |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1320 after starting up? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1321 |
2072 | 1322 When showing a diff between a non-existent file and an existing one, with the |
1624 | 1323 cursor in the empty buffer, the other buffer only shows the last line. Change |
1324 the "insert" into a change from one line to many? (Yakov Lerner, 2008 May 27) | |
1325 | |
1326 Add autocommand for when a tabpage is being closed. Also for when a tab page | |
1327 has been created. | |
1328 | |
1329 Using ":make" blocks Vim. Allow running one make in the background (if the | |
1330 shell supports it), catch errors in a file and update the error list on the | |
1331 fly. A bit like "!make > file&" and repeating ":cf file". ":bgmake", | |
1332 background make. ":bgcancel" interrupts it. | |
1333 A.Politz may work on this. | |
1125 | 1334 |
1335 These two abbreviations don't give the same result: | |
1336 let asdfasdf = "xyz\<Left>" | |
1337 cabbr XXX <C-R>=asdfasdf<CR> | |
1338 cabbr YYY xyz<Left> | |
1339 | |
1340 Michael Dietrich: maximized gvim sometimes displays output of external command | |
1341 partly. (2006 Dec 7) | |
1342 | |
1343 In FileChangedShell command it's no longer allowed to switch to another | |
1344 buffer. But the changed buffer may differ from the current buffer, how to | |
1345 reload it then? | |
1346 | |
1347 New syntax files for fstab and resolv from Radu Dineiu, David Necas did | |
1348 previous version. | |
1349 | |
1350 For Aap: include a config.arg.example file with hints how to use config.arg. | |
1351 | |
1624 | 1352 Command line completion when 'cmdheight' is maximum and 'wildmenu' is set, |
1353 only one buffer line displayed, causes display errors. | |
1354 | |
1355 Completing with 'wildmenu' and using <Up> and <Down> to move through directory | |
1356 tree stops unexpectedly when using ":cd " and entering a directory that | |
1357 doesn't contain other directories. | |
1358 | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1359 Setting 'background' resets the Normal background color: |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1360 highlight Normal ctermbg=DarkGray |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1361 set background=dark |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1362 This is undesired, 'background' is supposed to tell Vim what the background |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1363 color is, not reset it. |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
1364 |
1125 | 1365 Linux distributions: |
1366 - Suggest compiling xterm with --enable-tcap-query, so that nr of colors is | |
1367 known to Vim. 88 colors instead of 16 works better. See ":help | |
1368 xfree-xterm". | |
1369 - Suggest including bare "vi" and "vim" with X11, syntax, etc. | |
1370 | |
1371 Completion menu: For a wrapping line, completing a long file name, only the | |
1372 start of the path is shown in the menu. Should move the menu to the right to | |
1373 show more text of the completions. Shorten the items that don't fit in the | |
1374 middle? | |
1375 | |
1376 When running inside screen it's possible to kill the X server and restart it | |
1698 | 1377 (using pty's the program can keep on running). Vim dies because it loses the |
1125 | 1378 connection to the X server. Can Vim simply quit using the X server instead of |
1379 dying? Also relevant when running in a console. | |
1380 | |
1381 Accessing file#var in a function should not need the g: prepended. | |
1382 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1383 When exiting detects a modified buffer, instead of opening the buffer in the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1384 current tab, use an existing tab, if possible. Like finding a window where |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1385 the buffer is displayed. (Antonios Tsakiridis) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1386 |
1125 | 1387 When ":cn" moves to an error in the same line the message isn't shortened. |
1388 Only skip shortening for ":cc"? | |
1389 | |
1390 Write "making vim work better" for the docs (mostly pointers): *nice* | |
1391 - sourcing $VIMRUNTIME/vimrc_example.vim | |
1392 - setting 'mouse' to "a" | |
1393 - getting colors in xterm | |
1394 - compiling Vim with X11, GUI, etc. | |
1395 | |
1396 Problem with ":call" and dictionary function. Hari Krishna Dara, Charles | |
1397 Campbell 2006 Jul 06. | |
1398 | |
1399 Syntax HL error caused by "containedin". (Peter Hodge, 2006 Oct 6) | |
1400 | |
1624 | 1401 A custom completion function in a ":command" cannot be a Funcref. (Andy |
1402 Wokula, 2007 Aug 25) | |
1403 | |
1404 Problem with using :redir in user command completion function? (Hari Krishna | |
1405 Dara, 2006 June 21) | |
1406 | |
1125 | 1407 Another resizing problem when setting 'columns' and 'lines' to a very large |
1408 number. (Tony Mechelynck, 2007 Feb 6) | |
1409 | |
1410 After starting Vim, using '0 to jump somewhere in a file, ":sp" doesn't center | |
1411 the cursor line. It works OK after some other commands. | |
1412 | |
1413 Win32: Is it possible to have both postscript and Win32 printing? | |
1414 Does multi-byte printing with ":hardcopy" work? Add remark in documentation | |
1415 about this. | |
1416 | |
1417 Check: Running Vim in a console and still having connect to the X server for | |
1418 copy/paste: is stopping the X server handled gracefully? Should catch the X | |
1419 error and stop using the connection to the server. | |
1420 | |
1421 Problem with 'cdpath' on MS-Windows when a directory is equal to $HOME. (2006 | |
1422 Jul 26, Gary Johnson) | |
1423 | |
2174
755eb92c5961
Move items around in the todo list.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1424 Using UTF-8 character with ":command" does not work properly. (Matt Wozniski, |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1425 2008 Sep 29) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1426 |
1125 | 1427 In the Netbeans interface add a "vimeval" function, so that the other side can |
1428 check the result of has("patch13"). | |
1429 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1430 Cursor line at bottom of window instead of halfway after saving view and |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1431 restoring. Only with 'nowrap'. (Robert Webb, 2008 Aug 25) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1432 |
2709 | 1433 Netrw has trouble executing autocommands only for a directory. Add <isdir> |
1434 and <notisdir> to autocommand patterns? Also <isfile>? | |
1435 | |
1125 | 1436 Add command modifier that skips wildcard expansion, so that you don't need to |
1437 put backslashes before special chars, only for white space. | |
1438 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1439 Syntax HL: open two windows on the same C code, delete a ")" in one window, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1440 resulting in highlighted "{" in that window, not in the other. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1441 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1442 In mswin.vim: Instead of mapping <C-V> for Insert mode in a complicated way, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1443 can it be done like ":imap <C-V> <MiddleMouse>" without negative side effects? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1444 |
2908 | 1445 Completion menu disappears when using 'cursorcolumn'. (Sven-Hendrik Haase, |
1446 2011 May 23) | |
1447 | |
1624 | 1448 GTK: when the Tab pages bar appears or disappears while the window is |
1449 maximized the window is no longer maximized. Patch that has some idea but | |
1450 doesn't work from Geoffrey Antos, 2008 May 5. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1451 Also: the window may no longer fit on the screen, thus the command line is not |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1452 visible. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1453 |
2662 | 1454 When right after "vim file", "M" then CTRL-W v the windows are scrolled |
1455 differently and unexpectedly. Caused by patch 7.2.398? | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1456 |
1125 | 1457 The magic clipboard format "VimClipboard2" appears in several places. Should |
1458 be only one. | |
1459 | |
1624 | 1460 "vim -C" often has 'nocompatible', because it's set somewhere in a startup |
1461 script. Do "set compatible" after startup? | |
1462 | |
1125 | 1463 It's difficult to debug numbered functions (function in a Dictionary). Print |
1464 the function name before resolving it to a number? | |
1465 let d = {} | |
1466 fun! d.foo() | |
1467 echo "here" | |
1468 endfun | |
1469 call d.foo(9) | |
1470 | |
1471 Add a mark for the other end of the Visual area (VIsual pos). '< and '> are | |
1472 only set after Visual moded is ended. | |
1624 | 1473 Also add a variable for the Visual mode. So that this mode and '< '> can be |
1474 used to set what "gv" selects. (Ben Schmidt) | |
1475 | |
1476 Win32: When running ":make" and 'encoding' differs from the system locale, the | |
1477 output should be converted. Esp. when 'encoding' is "utf-8". (Yongwei Wu) | |
1478 Should we use 'termencoding' for this? | |
1479 | |
2283
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2282
diff
changeset
|
1480 Win32, NTFS: When editing a specific infostream directly and 'backupcopy' is |
1624 | 1481 "auto" should detect this situation and work like 'backupcopy' is "yes". File |
1482 name is something like "c:\path\foo.txt:bar", includes a colon. (Alex | |
1483 Jakushev, 2008 Feb 1) | |
1125 | 1484 |
1485 Small problem displaying diff filler line when opening windows with a script. | |
1486 (David Luyer, 2007 Mar 1 ~/Mail/oldmail/mool/in.15872 ) | |
1487 | |
1488 Is it allowed that 'backupext' is empty? Problems when backup is in same dir | |
1489 as original file? If it's OK don't compare with 'patchmode'. (Thierry Closen) | |
1490 | |
1491 Patch for supporting count before CR in quickfix window. (AOYAMA Shotaro, 2007 | |
1492 Jan 1) | |
1493 | |
1624 | 1494 Patch for adding ":lscscope". (Navdeep Parhar, 2007 Apr 26; update 2008 Apr |
1495 23) | |
1496 | |
1497 ":mkview" isn't called with the right buffer argument. Happens when using | |
1498 tabs and the autocommand "autocmd BufWinLeave * mkview". (James Vega, 2007 | |
1499 Jun 18) | |
1125 | 1500 |
1501 xterm should be able to pass focus changes to Vim, so that Vim can check for | |
1502 buffers that changed. Perhaps in misc.c, function selectwindow(). | |
1503 Xterm 224 supports it! | |
1504 | |
1505 When completing from another file that uses a different encoding completion | |
1506 text has the wrong encoding. E.g., when 'encoding' is utf-8 and file is | |
1507 latin1. Example from Gombault Damien, 2007 Mar 24. | |
1508 | |
1624 | 1509 Is it possible to use "foo#var" instead of "g:foo#var" inside a function? |
1510 | |
1511 Syntax HL: When using "nextgroup" and the group has an empty match, there is | |
1512 no search at that position for another match. (Lukas Mai, 2008 April 11) | |
1513 | |
1514 In gvim the backspace key produces a backspace character, but on Linux the | |
1515 VERASE key is Delete. Set VERASE to Backspace? (patch by Stephane Chazelas, | |
1516 2007 Oct 16) | |
1517 | |
1518 TermResponse autocommand isn't always triggered when using vimdiff. (Aron | |
1519 Griffis, 2007 Sep 19) | |
1520 | |
1521 Create a gvimtutor.1 file and change Makefiles to install it. | |
1522 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1523 When 'encoding' is utf-8 typing text at the end of the line causes previously |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1524 typed characters to be redrawn. Caused by patch 7.1.329. (Tyler Spivey, 2008 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1525 Sep 3, 11) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1526 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1527 When Vim in an xterm owns the selection and the user does ":shell" Vim doesn't |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1528 respond to selection requests. Invoking XtDisownSelection() before executing |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1529 the shell doesn't help. Would require forking and doing a message loop, like |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1530 what happens for the GUI. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1531 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1532 X11: Putting more than about 262040 characters of text on the clipboard and |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1533 pasting it in another Vim doesn't work. (Dominique Pelle, 2008 Aug 21-23) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1534 clip_x11_request_selection_cb() is called with zero value and length. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1535 Also: Get an error message from free() in the process that owns the selection. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1536 Seems to happen when the selection is requested the second time, but before |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1537 clip_x11_convert_selection_cb() is invoked, thus in X library code. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1538 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1539 ":vimgrep" does not recognize a recursive symlink. Is it possible to detect |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1540 this, at least for Unix (using device/inode)? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1541 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1542 When switching between windows the cursor is often put in the middle. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1543 Remember the relative position and restore that, just like lnum and col are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1544 restored. (Luc St-Louis) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1545 |
2282
a888ed7ba375
Make updating text for conceal mode simpler. A few compiler warning fixes.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2280
diff
changeset
|
1546 Patch to support horizontal scroll wheel in GTK. Untested. (Bjorn Winckler, |
a888ed7ba375
Make updating text for conceal mode simpler. A few compiler warning fixes.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2280
diff
changeset
|
1547 2010 Jun 30) |
1125 | 1548 |
1549 | |
2709 | 1550 At next release: |
1551 - Rename src/Makefile and create a new one like toplevel Makefile that | |
1552 creates auto/config.mk when it's not there? (Ben Schmidt, 2011 Feb 11) | |
3224 | 1553 - Improve plugin handling: Automatic updates, handle dependencies? |
1554 E.g. Vundle: https://github.com/gmarik/vundle | |
2709 | 1555 |
1556 | |
1624 | 1557 More patches: |
2319
c79ccf947487
Fix: When entering a digraph or special character after a line that fits the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2318
diff
changeset
|
1558 - Another patch for Javascript indenting. (Hari Kumar, 2010 Jul 11) |
c79ccf947487
Fix: When entering a digraph or special character after a line that fits the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2318
diff
changeset
|
1559 Needs a few tests. |
1125 | 1560 - Add 'cscopeignorecase' option. (Liang Wenzhi, 2006 Sept 3) |
1561 - Argument for feedkeys() to prepend to typeahead (Yakov Lerner, 2006 Oct | |
1562 21) | |
1563 - Load intl.dll too, not only libintl.dll. (Mike Williams, 2006 May 9, docs | |
1564 patch May 10) | |
1565 - Extra argument to strtrans() to translate special keys to their name (Eric | |
1566 Arnold, 2006 May 22) | |
1567 - 'threglookexp' option: only match with first word in thesaurus file. | |
1568 (Jakson A. Aquino, 2006 Jun 14) | |
1569 - Mac: indicate whether a buffer was modified. (Nicolas Weber, 2006 Jun 30) | |
1570 - Allow negative 'nrwidth' for left aligning. (Nathan Laredo, 2006 Aug 16) | |
1571 - ml_append_string(): efficiently append to an existing line. (Brad | |
1572 Beveridge, 2006 Aug 26) Use in some situations, e.g., when pasting a | |
1573 character at a time? | |
1574 - recognize hex numbers better. (Mark Manning, 2006 Sep 13) | |
1698 | 1575 - Add <AbbrExpand> key, to expand an abbreviation in a mapping. (Kana |
1576 Natsuno, 2008 Jul 17) | |
1577 - Add 'wspara' option, also accept blank lines like empty lines for "{" and | |
1578 "}". (Mark Lundquist, 2008 Jul 18) | |
1579 - Patch to add CTRL-T to delete part of a path on cmdline. (Adek, 2008 Jul | |
1580 21) | |
1581 - Instead of creating a copy of the tutor in all the shell scripts, do it in | |
1582 vimtutor.vim. (Jan Minar, 2008 Jul 20) | |
1583 - When fsync() fails there is no hint about what went wrong. Patch by Ben | |
1584 Schmidt, 2008 Jul 22. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1585 - testdir/Make_dos_sh.mak for running tests with MingW. (Bill Mccarthy, 2008 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1586 Sep 13) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1587 - Patch for adding "space" item in 'listchars'. (Jérémie Roquet, 2009 Oct 29, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1588 Docs patch Oct 30) |
2319
c79ccf947487
Fix: When entering a digraph or special character after a line that fits the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2318
diff
changeset
|
1589 - Replace ccomplete.vim by cppcomplete.vim from www.vim.org? script 1520 by |
c79ccf947487
Fix: When entering a digraph or special character after a line that fits the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2318
diff
changeset
|
1590 Vissale Neang. (Martin Stubenschrott) Asked Vissale to make the scripts |
c79ccf947487
Fix: When entering a digraph or special character after a line that fits the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2318
diff
changeset
|
1591 more friendly for the Vim distribution. |
c79ccf947487
Fix: When entering a digraph or special character after a line that fits the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2318
diff
changeset
|
1592 New version received 2008 Jan 6. |
c79ccf947487
Fix: When entering a digraph or special character after a line that fits the
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2318
diff
changeset
|
1593 No maintenance in two years... |
2343
0703d2fd5749
Last few changes for the 7.3a BETA release.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2342
diff
changeset
|
1594 - Patch to access screen under Python. (Marko Mahni, 2010 Jul 18) |
2479 | 1595 - Patch to open dropped files in new tabs. (Michael Trim, 2010 Aug 3) |
857 | 1596 |
40 | 1597 Awaiting updated patches: |
842 | 1598 9 Mac unicode patch (Da Woon Jung, Eckehard Berns): |
1599 8 Add patch from Muraoka Taro (Mar 16) to support input method on Mac? | |
1600 New patch 2004 Jun 16 | |
1601 - selecting proportional font breaks display | |
1602 - UTF-8 text causes display problems. Font replacement causes this. | |
1603 - Command-key mappings do not work. (Alan Schmitt) | |
1604 - With 'nopaste' pasting is wrong, with 'paste' Command-V doesn't work. | |
1605 (Alan Schmitt) | |
1606 - remove 'macatsui' option when this has been fixed. | |
1125 | 1607 - when 'macatsui' is off should we always convert to "macroman" and ignore |
1608 'termencoding'? | |
800 | 1609 9 HTML indenting can be slow. Caused by using searchpair(). Can search() |
1624 | 1610 be used instead? A.Politz is looking into a solution. |
844 | 1611 8 Win32: Add minidump generation. (George Reilly, 2006 Apr 24) |
713 | 1612 8 Add ":n" to fnamemodify(): normalize path, remove "../" when possible. |
856 | 1613 Aric Blumer has a patch for this. He will update the patch for 6.3. |
713 | 1614 7 Completion of network shares, patch by Yasuhiro Matsumoto. |
1615 Update 2004 Sep 6. | |
1616 How does this work? Missing comments. | |
1617 - Patch for 'breakindent' option: repeat indent for wrapped line. (Vaclav | |
1624 | 1618 Smilauer, 2004 Sep 13, fix Oct 31, update 2007 May 30) |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
1619 Version for latest MacVim: Tobia Conforto, 2009 Nov 23 |
2965 | 1620 More recent version: https://retracile.net/wiki/VimBreakIndent |
3224 | 1621 Posted to vim-dev by Taylor Hedberg, 2011 Nov 25 |
713 | 1622 8 Add a few more command names to the menus. Patch from Jiri Brezina |
832 | 1623 (28 feb 2002). Will mess the translations... |
713 | 1624 7 ATTENTION dialog choices are more logical when "Delete it' appears |
1625 before "Quit". Patch by Robert Webb, 2004 May 3. | |
1626 - Include flipcase patch: ~/vim/patches/wall.flipcase2 ? Make it work | |
1627 for multi-byte characters. | |
1628 - Win32: add options to print dialog. Patch from Vipin Aravind. | |
1629 - Patch to add highlighting for whitespace. (Tom Schumm, 2003 Jul 5) | |
1630 use the patch that keeps using HLF_8 if HLF_WS has not | |
1631 been given values. | |
1632 Add section in help files for these highlight groups? | |
1633 8 "fg" and "bg" don't work in an xterm. Get default colors from xterm | |
827 | 1634 with an ESC sequence. |
1635 xterm can send colors for many things. E.g. for the cursor: | |
1636 <Esc>]12;?<Bel> | |
1637 Can use this to get the background color and restore the colors on exit. | |
713 | 1638 7 Add "DefaultFG" and "DefaultBG" for the colors of the menu. (Marcin |
1639 Dalecki has a patch for Motif and Carbon) | |
1640 - Add possibility to highlight specific columns (for Fortran). Or put a | |
1641 line in between columns (e.g., for 'textwidth'). | |
1642 Patch to add 'hlcolumn' from Vit Stradal, 2004 May 20. | |
1643 8 Add functions: | |
1644 gettext() Translate a message. (Patch from Yasuhiro Matsumoto) | |
40 | 1645 Update 2004 Sep 10 |
557 | 1646 Another patch from Edward L. Fox (2005 Nov 24) |
1647 Search in 'runtimepath'? | |
832 | 1648 More docs needed about how to use this. |
40 | 1649 How to get the messages into the .po files? |
2338
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2330
diff
changeset
|
1650 strchars() Like strlen() and strwidth() but counting characters |
da6ec32d8d8f
Added strwidth() and strchars() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2330
diff
changeset
|
1651 instead of bytes. |
713 | 1652 confirm() add "flags" argument, with 'v' for vertical |
1653 layout and 'c' for console dialog. (Haegg) | |
1654 Flemming Madsen has a patch for the 'c' flag | |
1655 (2003 May 13) | |
1656 raisewin() raise gvim window (see HierAssist patch for | |
1657 Tcl implementation ~/vim/HierAssist/ ) | |
1125 | 1658 taglist() add argument to specify maximum number of matches. |
1659 useful for interactive things or completion. | |
1624 | 1660 col('^') column of first non-white character. |
1661 Can use "len(substitute(getline('.'), '\S.*', '', '')) | |
1662 + 1", but that's ugly. | |
713 | 1663 7 Add patch from Benoit Cerrina to integrate Vim and Perl functions |
1664 better. Now also works for Ruby (2001 Nov 10) | |
1665 - Patch from Herculano de Lima Einloft Neto for better formatting of the | |
1666 quickfix window (2004 dec 2) | |
1667 7 When 'rightleft' is set, the search pattern should be displayed right | |
1668 to left as well? See patch of Dec 26. (Nadim Shaikli) | |
832 | 1669 8 Option to lock all used memory so that it doesn't get swapped to disk |
1670 (uncrypted). Patch by Jason Holt, 2003 May 23. Uses mlock. | |
713 | 1671 7 Add ! register, for shell commands. (patch from Grenie) |
1672 8 In the gzip plugin, also recognize *.gz.orig, *.gz.bak, etc. Like it's | |
1673 done for filetype detection. Patch from Walter Briscoe, 2003 Jul 1. | |
1674 7 Add a "-@ filelist" argument: read file names from a file. (David | |
1675 Kotchan has a patch for it) | |
1676 8 Include a connection to an external program through a pipe? See | |
1677 patches from Felbinger for a mathematica interface. | |
1678 Or use emacs server kind of thing? | |
1679 7 Add ":justify" command. Patch from Vit Stradal 2002 Nov 25. | |
1680 - findmatch() should be adjusted for Lisp. See remark at | |
1681 get_lisp_indent(). Esp. \( and \) should be skipped. (Dorai Sitaram, | |
1682 incomplete patch Mar 18) | |
1683 - For GUI Find/Replace dialog support using a regexp. Patch for Motif | |
1684 and GTK by degreneir (nov 10 and nov 18). | |
1685 - Patch for "paranoid mode" by Kevin Collins, March 7. Needs much more work. | |
70 | 1686 |
1687 | |
7 | 1688 Vi incompatibility: |
713 | 1689 - Try new POSIX tests, made after my comments. (Geoff Clare, 2005 April 7) |
1690 Version 1.5 is in ~/src/posix/1.5. (Lynne Canal) | |
7 | 1691 8 With undo/redo only marks in the changed lines should be changed. Other |
1692 marks should be kept. Vi keeps each mark at the same text, even when it | |
1693 is deleted or restored. (Webb) | |
1694 Also: A mark is lost after: make change, undo, redo and undo. | |
1695 Example: "{d''" then "u" then "d''": deletes an extra line, because the '' | |
1696 position is one line down. (Veselinovic) | |
1697 8 When stdin is not a tty, and Vim reads commands from it, an error should | |
1698 make Vim exit. | |
1699 7 Unix Vim (not gvim): Typing CTRL-C in Ex mode should finish the line | |
1700 (currently you can continue typing, but it's truncated later anyway). | |
1701 Requires a way to make CTRL-C interrupt select() when in cooked input. | |
1702 8 When loading a file in the .exrc, Vi loads the argument anyway. Vim skips | |
1703 loading the argument if there is a file already. When no file argument | |
1704 given, Vi starts with an empty buffer, Vim keeps the loaded file. (Bearded) | |
1705 6 In Insert mode, when using <BS> or <Del>, don't wipe out the text, but | |
1706 only move back the cursor. Behaves like '$' in 'cpoptions'. Use a flag | |
1707 in 'cpoptions' to switch this on/off. | |
1708 8 When editing a file which is a symbolic link, and then opening another | |
1709 symbolic link on the same file, Vim uses the name of the first one. | |
1710 Adjust the file name in the buffer to the last one used? Use several file | |
1711 names in one buffer??? | |
1712 Also: When first editing file "test", which is symlink to "test2", and | |
1713 then editing "test2", you end up editing buffer "test" again. It's not | |
1714 logical that the name that was first used sticks with the buffer. | |
1715 7 The ":undo" command works differently in Ex mode. Edit a file, make some | |
1716 changes, "Q", "undo" and _all_ changes are undone, like the ":visual" | |
1717 command was one command. | |
321 | 1718 On the other hand, an ":undo" command in an Ex script only undoes the last |
1719 change (e.g., use two :append commands, then :undo). | |
7 | 1720 7 The ":map" command output overwrites the command. Perhaps it should keep |
1721 the ":map" when it's used without arguments? | |
1722 7 CTRL-L is not the end of a section? It is for Posix! Make it an option. | |
1723 7 Implement 'prompt' option. Init to off when stdin is not a tty. | |
1724 7 CTRL-T in Insert mode inserts 'shiftwidth' of spaces at the cursor. Add a | |
1725 flag in 'cpoptions' for this. | |
1726 7 Add a way to send an email for a crashed edit session. Create a file when | |
1727 making changes (containing name of the swap file), delete it when writing | |
1728 the file. Supply a program that can check for crashed sessions (either | |
1729 all, for a system startup, or for one user, for in a .login file). | |
1730 7 Vi doesn't do autoindenting when input is not from a tty (in Ex mode). | |
1731 7 "z3<CR>" should still use the whole window, but only redisplay 3 lines. | |
1732 7 ":tag xx" should move the cursor to the first non-blank. Or should it go | |
1733 to the match with the tag? Option? | |
1734 7 Implement 'autoprint'/'ap' option. | |
1735 7 Add flag in 'cpoptions' that makes <BS> after a count work like <Del> | |
1736 (Sayre). | |
1737 7 Add flag in 'cpoptions' that makes operator (yank, filter) not move the | |
1738 cursor, at least when cancelled. (default Vi compatible). | |
1739 7 This Vi-trick doesn't work: "Q" to go to Ex mode, then "g/pattern/visual". | |
1740 In Vi you can edit in visual mode, and when doing "Q" you jump to the next | |
1741 match. Nvi can do it too. | |
1742 7 Support '\' for line continuation in Ex mode for these commands: (Luebking) | |
1743 g/./a\ g/pattern1/ s/pattern2/rep1\\ | |
1744 line 1\ line 2\\ | |
1745 line 2\ line 3\\ | |
1746 . line4/ | |
1747 6 ":e /tmp/$tty" doesn't work. ":e $uid" does. Is $tty not set because of | |
1748 the way the shell is started? | |
1749 6 Vi compatibility (optional): make "ia<CR><ESC>10." do the same strange | |
1750 thing. (only repeat insert for the first line). | |
1751 | |
1752 | |
1753 GTK+ GUI known bugs: | |
713 | 1754 9 Crash with X command server over ssh. (Ciaran McCreesh, 2006 Feb 6) |
7 | 1755 8 GTK 2: Combining UTF-8 characters not displayed properly in menus (Mikolaj |
1756 Machowski) They are displayed as separate characters. Problem in | |
1757 creating a label? | |
497 | 1758 8 GTK 2: Combining UTF-8 characters are sometimes not drawn properly. |
1759 Depends on the font size, "monospace 13" has the problem. Vim seems to do | |
1760 everything right, must be a GTK bug. Is there a way to work around it? | |
7 | 1761 9 Can't paste a Visual selection from GTK-gvim to vim in xterm or Motif gvim |
1762 when it is longer than 4000 characters. Works OK from gvim to gvim and | |
1763 vim to vim. Pasting through xterm (using the shift key) also works. | |
1764 It starts working after GTK gvim loses the selection and gains it again. | |
795 | 1765 - Gnome2: When moving the toolbar out of the dock, so that it becomes |
1766 floating, it can no longer be moved. Therefore making it float has been | |
1767 blocked for now. | |
1768 | |
7 | 1769 |
1770 Win32 GUI known bugs: | |
713 | 1771 - Win32: tearoff menu window should have a scrollbar when it's taller than |
1772 the screen. | |
1125 | 1773 8 non-ASCII font names don't work. Need to convert from 'encoding' and use |
1774 the wide functions. | |
7 | 1775 8 On Windows 98 the unicows library is needed to support functions with UCS2 |
1776 file names. Can we load unicows.dll dynamically? | |
1777 8 The -P argument doesn't work very well with many MDI applications. | |
1778 The last argument of CreateWindowEx() should be used, see MSDN docs. | |
1779 Tutorial: http://win32assembly.online.fr/tut32.html | |
1780 8 In eval.c, io.h is included when MSWIN32 is defined. Shouldn't this be | |
1781 WIN32? Or can including io.h be moved to vim.h? (Dan Sharp) | |
1782 7 Windows XP: When using "ClearType" for text smoothing, a column of yellow | |
1783 pixels remains when typing spaces in front of a "D" ('guifont' set to | |
1784 "lucida_console:h8"). | |
1785 6 Win32 GUI: With "-u NONE -U NONE" and doing "CTRL-W v" "CTRL-W o", the ":" | |
1786 of ":only" is highlighted like the cursor. (Lipelis) | |
22 | 1787 8 When 'encoding' is "utf-8", should use 'guifont' for both normal and wide |
1788 characters to make Asian languages work. Win32 fonts contain both | |
1789 type of characters. | |
7 | 1790 7 When font smoothing is enabled, redrawing can become very slow. The reason |
1791 appears to be drawing with a transparent background. Would it be possible | |
1792 to use an opaque background in most places? | |
1793 8 Use another default for 'termencoding': the active codepage. Means that | |
1794 when 'encoding' is changed typing characters still works properly. | |
1795 Alternative: use the Unicode functions to obtain typed characters. | |
1796 8 Win32: Multi-byte characters are not displayed, even though the same font | |
1797 in Notepad can display them. (Srinath Avadhanula) Try with the | |
1798 UTF-8-demo.txt page with Andale Mono. | |
1799 7 The cursor color indicating IME mode doesn't work properly. (Shizhu Pan, | |
1800 2004 May 9) | |
1801 8 Win32: When clicking on the gvim title bar, which gives it focus, produces | |
1802 a file-changed dialog, after clicking on a button in that dialog the gvim | |
1803 window follows the mouse. The button-up event is lost. Only with | |
1804 MS-Windows 98? | |
1805 Try this: ":set sw ts", get enter-prompt, then change the file in a | |
1806 console, go back to Vim and click "reload" in the dialog for the changed | |
1807 file: Window moves with the cursor! | |
1808 Put focus event in input buffer and let generic Vim code handle it? | |
1809 8 Win32: When mouse is hidden and in the toolbar, moving it won't make it | |
1810 appear. (Sami Salonen) | |
1811 8 Win32 GUI: With maximized window, ":set go-=r" doesn't use the space that | |
1812 comes available. (Poucet) It works OK on Win 98 but doesn't work on Win | |
1813 NT 4.0. Leaves a grey area where the scrollbar was. ":set go+=r" also | |
1814 doesn't work properly. | |
1815 8 When Vim is minimized and when maximizing it a file-changed dialog pops | |
1816 up, Vim isn't maximized. It should be done before the dialog, so that it | |
1817 appears in the right position. (Webb) | |
1818 9 When selecting at the more-prompt or hit-enter-prompt, the right mouse | |
1819 button doesn't give popup menu. | |
1820 At the hit-enter prompt CTRL-Y doesn't work to copy the modeless | |
1821 selection. | |
1822 On the command line, don't get a popup menu for the right mouse button. | |
1823 Let the middle button paste selected text (not the clipboard but the | |
1824 non-Visual selection)? Otherwise CTRL-Y has to be used to copy the text. | |
1825 8 When 'grepprg' doesn't execute, the error only flashes by, the | |
1826 user can hardly see what is wrong. (Moore) | |
1827 Could use vimrun with an "-nowait" argument to only wait when an error | |
1828 occurs, but "command.com" doesn't return an error code. | |
1829 8 When the 'shell' cannot be executed, should give an appropriate error msg. | |
1830 Esp. for a filter command, currently it only complains the file could not | |
1831 be read. | |
1832 7 Add an option to add one pixel column to the character width? Lucida | |
1833 Console italic is wider than the normal font ("d" overlaps with next char). | |
1834 Opposite of 'linespace': 'columnspace'. | |
1835 7 At the hit-enter prompt scrolling now no longer works. Need to use the | |
1836 keyboard to get around this. Pretend <CR> was hit when the user tries to | |
533 | 1837 scroll? |
7 | 1838 7 Scrollbar width doesn't change when selecting other windows appearance. |
1839 Also background color of Toolbar and rectangle below vert. scrollbar. | |
1840 6 Drawing text transparently doesn't seem to work (when drawing part cursor). | |
1841 8 CTRL key doesn't always work in combination with ALT key. It does work | |
1842 for function keys, not for alphabetic characters. Perhaps this is because | |
1843 CTRL-ALT is used by Windows as AltGr? | |
1844 8 CTRL-- doesn't work for AZERTY, because it's CTRL-[ for QWERTY. How do we | |
1845 know which keyboard is being used? | |
1846 7 When scrolling, and a background color is dithered, the dither pattern | |
1847 doesn't always join correctly between the scrolled area and the new drawn | |
1848 area (Koloseike). | |
1849 8 When gui_init_font() is called with "*", p_guifont is freed while it might | |
1850 still be used somewhere. This is too tricky, do the font selection first, | |
1851 then set the new font by name (requires putting all logfont parameters in | |
1852 the font name). | |
1853 | |
1854 | |
1855 Athena and Motif: | |
169 | 1856 6 New Motif toolbar button from Marcin Dalecki: |
1857 - When the mouse pointer is over an Agide button the red becomes black. | |
1858 Something with the way colors are specified in the .xpm file. | |
1859 - The pixmap is two pixels smaller than it should be. The gap is filled | |
1860 with grey instead of the current toolbar background color. | |
7 | 1861 9 Can configure be changed to disable netbeans if the Xpm library is |
1862 required and it's missing? | |
1863 8 When using the resource "Vim*borderwidth 2" the widgets are positioned | |
1864 wrong. | |
1865 9 XIM is disabled by default for SGI/IRIX. Fix XIM so that 'imdisable' can | |
1866 be off by default. | |
237 | 1867 9 XIM doesn't work properly for Athena/Motif. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto) For now, |
7 | 1868 keep XIM active at all times when the input method has the preediting |
1869 flag. | |
1870 8 X11: A menu that contains an umlaut is truncated at that character. | |
1871 Happens when the locale is "C", which uses ASCII instead of IS0-8859-1. | |
1872 Is there a way to use latin1 by default? Gnome_init() seems to do this. | |
1873 8 Perhaps use fontsets for everything? | |
1874 6 When starting in English and switching the language to Japanese, setting | |
1875 the locale with ":lang", 'guifontset' and "hi menu font=", deleting all | |
1876 menus and setting them again, the menus don't use the new font. Most of | |
1877 the tooltips work though... | |
1878 7 Motif: when using a file selection dialog, the specified file name is not | |
1879 always used (when specifying a filter or another directory). | |
1880 8 When 'encoding' is different from the current locale (e.g., utf-8) the | |
1881 menu strings don't work. Requires conversion from 'encoding' to the | |
1882 current locale. Workaround: set 'langmenu'. | |
1883 | |
1884 | |
1885 Athena GUI: | |
2642 | 1886 9 The first event for any button in the menu or toolbar appears to get lost. |
1887 The second click on a menu does work. | |
7 | 1888 9 When dragging the scrollbar thumb very fast, focus is only obtained in |
1889 the scrollbar itself. And the thumb is no longer updated when moving | |
1890 through files. | |
1891 7 The file selector is not resizable. With a big font it is difficult to | |
1892 read long file names. (Schroeder) | |
1893 4 Re-write the widget attachments and code so that we will not have to go | |
1894 through and calculate the absolute position of every widget every time the | |
1895 window is refreshed/changes size. This will help the "flashing-widgets" | |
1896 problem during a refresh. | |
1897 5 When starting gvim with all the default colors and then typing | |
1898 ":hi Menu guibg=cyan", the menus change color but the background of the | |
1899 pullright pixmap doesn't change colors. | |
1900 If you type ":hi Menu guibg=cyan font=anyfont", then the pixmap changes | |
1901 colors as it should. | |
1902 Allocating a new pixmap and setting the resource doesn't change the | |
1903 pullright pixmap's colors. Why? Possible Athena bug? | |
1904 | |
1905 | |
1906 Motif GUI: | |
2587 | 1907 - gui_mch_browsedir() is missing, browsedir() doesn't work nicely. |
7 | 1908 7 Use XmStringCreateLocalized() instead of XmStringCreateSimple()? |
1909 David Harrison says it's OK (it exists in Motif 1.2). | |
1910 8 Lesstif: When deleting a menu that's torn off, the torn off menu becomes | |
1911 very small instead of disappearing. When closing it, Vim crashes. | |
1912 (Phillipps) | |
1913 | |
1914 | |
1915 GUI: | |
1916 9 On Solaris, creating the popup menu causes the right mouse button no | |
1917 longer to work for extending the selection. (Halevy) | |
1918 9 When running an external program, it can't always be killed with CTRL-C. | |
387 | 1919 e.g., on Solaris 5.5, when using "K" (Keech). Other 'guipty' problems on |
7 | 1920 Solaris 2.6. (Marley) |
1921 9 On Solaris: Using a "-geometry" argument, bigger than the window where Vim | |
1922 is started from, causes empty lines below the cmdline. (raf) | |
1923 8 X11 GUI: When menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', ALT key | |
1924 should not be used to trigger a menu (like the Win32 version). | |
1925 8 When setting 'langmenu', it should be effective immediately. Store both | |
1926 the English and the translated text in the menu structure. Re-generate | |
1927 the translation when 'langmenu' has changed. | |
1928 8 Basic flaw in the GUI code: NextScreen is updated before calling | |
1929 gui_write(), but the GUI code relies on NextScreen to represent the state | |
1930 of where it is processing the output. | |
1931 Need better separation of Vim core and GUI code. | |
1932 8 When fontset support is enabled, setting 'guifont' to a single font | |
1933 doesn't work. | |
1934 8 Menu priority for sub-menus for: Amiga, BeOS. | |
720 | 1935 8 When translating menus ignore the part after the Tab, the shortcut. So |
1936 that the same menu item with a different shortcut (e.g., for the Mac) are | |
1937 still translated. | |
2826 | 1938 8 Add menu separators for Amiga. |
7 | 1939 8 Add way to specify the file filter for the browse dialog. At least for |
1940 browse(). | |
1941 8 Add dialog for search/replace to other GUIs? Tk has something for this, | |
1942 use that code? Or use console dialog. | |
1943 8 When selecting a font with the font dialog and the font is invalid, the | |
1944 error message disappears too quick. | |
169 | 1945 7 More features in the find/replace dialog: |
1946 - regexp on/off | |
1947 - search in selection/buffer/all buffers/directory | |
1948 when all buffers/directory is used: | |
1949 - filter for file name | |
1950 when directory is used: | |
1951 - subdirectory on/off | |
1952 - top directory browser | |
7 | 1953 8 gui_check_colors() is not called at the right moment. Do it much later, |
1954 to avoid problems. | |
1955 8 gui_update_cursor() is called for a cursor shape change, even when there | |
1956 are mappings to be processed. Only do something when going to wait for | |
1957 input. Or maybe every 100 ms? | |
1958 8 X11: When the window size is reduced to fit on screen, there are blank | |
1959 lines below the text and bottom scrollbar. "gvim -geometry 80x78+0+0". | |
1960 When the "+0+0" is omitted it works. | |
1961 8 When starting an external command, and 'guipty' set, BS and DEL are mixed | |
1962 up. Set erase character somehow? | |
1963 8 A dead circumflex followed by a space should give the '^' character | |
1964 (Rommel). Look how xterm does this. | |
1965 Also: Bednar has some code for dead key handling. | |
1966 Also: Nedit 5.0.2 with USE_XMIM does it right. (Gaya) | |
1967 8 The compose key doesn't work properly (Cepas). Both for Win32 and X11. | |
1968 7 The cursor in an inactive window should be hollow. Currently it's not | |
1969 visible. | |
1970 7 GUI on Solaris 2.5.1, using /usr/dt/..: When gvim starts, cursor is | |
1971 hollow, after window lowered/raised it's OK. (Godfrey) | |
1972 7 When starting GUI with ":gui", and window is made smaller because it | |
1973 doesn't fit on the screen, there is an extra redraw. | |
1974 8 When setting font with .Xdefaults, there is an extra empty line at the | |
1975 bottom, which disappears when using ":set guifont=<Tab>". (Chadzelek) | |
1976 8 When font shape changes, but not the size, doing ":set font=" does not | |
1977 redraw the screen with the new font. Also for Win32. | |
1978 When the size changes, on Solaris 2.5 there isn't a redraw for the | |
1979 remaining part of the window (Phillipps). | |
1980 - Flashes really badly in certain cases when running remotely from a Sun. | |
1981 4 Re-write the code so that the highlighting isn't changed multiple times | |
1982 when doing a ":hi clear". The color changes happen three or more times | |
1983 currently. This is very obvious on a 66Mhz 486. | |
1984 | |
1985 | |
1986 MSDOS/DJGPP: | |
1987 9 Pressing CTRL-C often crashes the console Vim runs in. (Ken Liao) | |
1988 When 'bioskey' isn't set it doesn't happen. Could be a problem with the | |
1989 BIOS emulation of the console. Version 5.6 already had this problem. | |
1990 8 DJGPP: "cd c:" can take us to a directory that no longer exists. | |
1991 change_drive() doesn't check this. How to check for this error? | |
1992 9 The 16 bit version runs out of memory very quickly. Should find unused | |
818 | 1993 code and reduce static data. Resetting 'writebackup' helps to be able to |
1994 write a file. | |
7 | 1995 9 Crash when running on Windows 98 in a console window and pressing CTRL-C. |
1996 Happens now and then. When debugging Vim in gdb this also happens. Since | |
1997 the console crashes, might be a bug in the DOS console. Resetting | |
1998 'bioskey' avoids it, but then CTRL-C doesn't work. | |
1999 9 DOS: Make CTRL-Fx and ALT-Fx work. | |
2000 CTRL-F1 = CE-5E, CTRL-F2 = CE-5F, .., CTRL-F10 = CE-67 | |
2001 ALT-F1 = CE-68, ALT-F2 = CE-69, .., ALT-F10 = CE-71 | |
2002 Shifted cursor keys produce same codes as unshifted keys. Use bioskey(2) | |
2003 to get modifier mask for <S-C-M-Fx>. | |
2004 Use K_SPECIAL/KS_MODIFIER codes to insert modifier mask in input stream? | |
2005 Make this work like in Win32 console. | |
2006 Mapping things like <M-A> doesn't work, because it generates an extended | |
2007 key code. Use a translation table? | |
2008 9 Can't read an opened swap file when the "share" command has not been used. | |
2009 At least ignore the swap files that Vim has opened itself. | |
2010 8 Use DJGPP 2.03. | |
2011 8 The Dos32 version (DJGPP) can't use long file names on Windows NT. | |
2012 Check if new package can be used (v2misc/ntlfn08[bs].zip). | |
2013 8 setlocale() is bogus. | |
2014 8 Vim busy waits for new characters or mouse clicks. Should put in some | |
2015 sort of sleep, to avoid eating 50% of the CPU time. Test on an unpatched | |
2016 Windows 95 system! | |
2017 8 DJGPP: when shell is bash, make fails. (Donahoe) | |
387 | 2018 7 Hitting CTRL-P twice quickly (e.g., in keyword completion) on a 8088 |
7 | 2019 machine, starts printer echo! (John Mullin). |
2020 7 MSDOS 16 bit version can't work with COMSPEC that has an argument, e.g.: | |
2021 COMSPEC=C:\WINDOWS\COMMAND.COM /E:4096 (Bradley) | |
2022 Caused by BCC system() function (Borland "make" has the same problem). | |
2023 8 Mouse: handle left&right button pressed as middle button pressed. Add | |
2024 modifier keys shift, ctrl and alt. | |
2025 7 When too many files are open (depends on FILES), strange things happen. | |
2026 The Dos16 version runs out of memory, in the Dos32 version "!ls" causes a | |
2027 crash. Another symptom: .swp files are not deleted, existing files are | |
2028 "[New file]". | |
2029 7 DJGPP version doesn't work with graphics display mode. Switch to a mode | |
2030 that is supported? | |
2031 8 DJGPP: ":mode" doesn't work for many modes. Disable them. | |
2032 8 DJGPP: When starting in Ex mode, shouldn't clear the screen. (Walter | |
2033 Briscoe) | |
2034 | |
2035 | |
2036 MSDOS, OS/2 and Win32: | |
2037 8 OS/2: Add backtick expansion. Undefine NO_EXPANDPATH and use | |
2038 gen_expand_wildcards(). | |
2039 8 OS/2: Add clipboard support? See example clipbrd.exe from Alexander | |
2040 Wagner. | |
2041 8 OS/2: Add Extended Attributes support and define HAVE_ACL. | |
2042 8 OS/2: When editing a file name "foo.txt" that is actually called FOO.txt, | |
2043 writing uses "foo.txt". Should obtain the real file name. | |
557 | 2044 8 Should $USERPROFILE be preferred above $HOMEDRIVE/$HOMEPATH? No, but it's |
2045 a good fallback, thus use: | |
2046 $HOME | |
2047 $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH | |
2048 SHGetSpecialFolderPath(NULL, lpzsPath, CSIDL_APPDATA, FALSE); | |
2049 $USERPROFILE | |
2050 SHGetSpecialFolderPath(NULL, lpzsPath, CSIDL_COMMON_APPDATA, FALSE); | |
2051 $ALLUSERSPROFILE | |
2052 $SYSTEMDRIVE\ | |
2053 C:\ | |
7 | 2054 8 Win32 console: <M-Up> and <M-Down> don't work. (Geddes) We don't have |
2055 special keys for these. Should use modifier + key. | |
2056 8 Win32 console: caps-lock makes non-alpha keys work like with shift. | |
2057 Should work like in the GUI version. | |
2058 8 Environment variables in DOS are not case sensitive. Make a define for | |
2059 STRCMP_ENV(), and use it when comparing environment var names. | |
2060 8 Setting 'shellslash' has no immediate effect. Change all file names when | |
2061 it is set/reset? Or only use it when actually executing a shell command? | |
2062 8 When editing a file on a Samba server, case might matter. ":e file" | |
2063 followed by ":e FILE" will edit "file" again, even though "FILE" might be | |
2064 another one. Set last used name in buflist_new()? Fix do_ecmd(), etc. | |
2065 8 When a buffer is editing a file like "ftp://mach/file", which is not going | |
2066 to be used like a normal file name, don't change the slashes to | |
2067 backslashes. (Ronald Hoellwarth) | |
2068 | |
2069 | |
2070 Windows 95: | |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
2071 8 Editing a file by its short file name and writing it, makes the long file |
7 | 2072 name disappear. Setting 'backupcopy' helps. |
2073 Use FindFirstFile()->cAlternateFileName in fname_case() (George Reilly). | |
2074 8 Doing wildcard expansion, will match the short filename, but result in the | |
2075 long filename (both DJGPP and Win32). | |
2076 | |
2077 | |
2078 Win32 console: | |
2079 9 When editing a file by its short file name, it should be expanded into its | |
2080 long file name, to avoid problems like these: (Mccollister) | |
2081 1) Create a file called ".bashrc" using some other editor. | |
2082 2) Drag that file onto a shortcut or the actual executable. | |
2083 3) Note that the file name is something like BASHRC~1 | |
2084 4) Go to File->Save As menu item and type ".bashrc" as the file name. | |
2085 5) Press "Yes" to indicate that I want to overwrite the file. | |
2086 6) Note that the message "File exists (add ! to override)" is displayed | |
2087 and the file is not saved. | |
2088 Use FindFirstFile() to expand a file name and directory in the path to its | |
2089 long name. | |
2090 8 Also implement 'conskey' option for the Win32 console version? Look at | |
2091 how Xvi does console I/O under Windows NT. | |
2092 7 Re-install the use of $TERM and support the use of different terminals, | |
2093 besides the console. | |
2094 8 Use of <altgr> modifier doesn't work? 5.3 was OK. (Garcia-Suarez/Guckes) | |
2095 9 Mapping <C-S-Tab> doesn't work correctly. How to see the difference with | |
2096 <C-S-i>? | |
2097 9 tmpnam() uses file in root of file system: "\asdf". That doesn't work on | |
2098 a Netware network drive. Use same function as for Win32 GUI? | |
2099 8 In os_win32.h, HAVE_STRICMP and HAVE_STRNICMP are defined only if __GNUC__ | |
2100 is not defined. Shouldn't that be the other way around? | |
2101 7 Use SetConsoleCP() and SetConsoleOutputCP() to implement 'termencoding'? | |
2102 Avoids that input and output work differently. Need to be restored when | |
2103 exiting. | |
2104 | |
2105 | |
2106 Amiga: | |
2107 8 In mch_inchar() should use convert_input_safe() to handle incomplete byte | |
2108 sequences. | |
2109 9 In mch_expandpath() a "*" is to be expanded, but "\*" isn't. Remove | |
2110 backslashes in result. | |
2111 8 Executing a shell, only one option for 'shell' is separated. Should do | |
2112 all options, using white space separation. | |
2113 | |
2114 | |
2115 Macintosh: | |
713 | 2116 - GUI: gui_mch_browsedir() is missing. |
7 | 2117 7 Loading the Perl library only works on OS/X 10.2 or 10.3, never on both. |
2118 Load the Perl library dynamically see Python sources file dynload_mac | |
2119 (Jack) | |
2120 dynamic linking: http://developer.apple.com/technotes/tn2002/tn2064.html | |
1125 | 2121 8 inputdialog() doesn't resize when giving more text lines. (David Fishburn, |
2122 2006 Sept 28) | |
7 | 2123 8 Define vim_mkdir() for Macintosh. |
2124 8 Define mch_writable() for Macintosh. | |
2125 9 When DiskLock is running, using a swap file causes a crash. Appears to be | |
2126 a problem with writing a file that starts with a dot. (Giacalone) | |
2127 9 In mac_expandpath() check that handling of backslashes is done properly. | |
2128 | |
2129 | |
2130 "Small" problems: | |
1624 | 2131 - Can't disable terminal flow control, to enable the use of CTRL-S and |
2132 CTRL-Q. Add an option for it? | |
1125 | 2133 - When using e_secure in do_one_cmd() mention the command being executed, |
2134 otherwise it's not clear where it comes from. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2135 - When the quickfix window is open and executing ":echo 'hello'" using the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2136 Command-line window, the text is immediately removed by the redrawing. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2137 (Michael Henry, 2008 Nov 1) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2138 Generic solution: When redrawing while there is a message on the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2139 cmdline, don't erase the display but draw over the existing text. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2140 Other solution, redraw after closing the cmdline window, before executing |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2141 the command. |
857 | 2142 9 For Turkish vim_tolower() and vim_toupper() also need to use utf_ |
2143 functions for characters below 0x80. (Sertacyildiz) | |
854 | 2144 9 When the last edited file is a help file, using '0 in a new Vim doesn't |
1668 | 2145 edit the file as a help file. 'filetype' is OK, but 'iskeyword' isn't, |
2146 file isn't readonly, etc. | |
7 | 2147 8 When an ":edit" is inside a try command and the ATTENTION prompt is used, |
2148 the :catch commands are always executed, also when the file is edited | |
2149 normally. Should reset did_emsg and undo side effects. Also make sure | |
16 | 2150 the ATTENTION message shows up. Servatius Brandt works on this. |
7 | 2151 8 ":g//" gives "Pattern not found error" with E486. Should not use the |
2152 error number, it's not a regular error message. | |
2153 7 Vimtutor leaves escape sequence in terminal. This is the xterm response to | |
2154 requesting the version number. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto) | |
2155 8 When redirecting and using ":silent" the current column for displaying and | |
2156 redirection can be different. Use a separate variable to hold the column | |
2157 for redirection. | |
2158 7 The messages for "vim --help" and "vim --version" don't use | |
2159 'termencoding'. | |
1125 | 2160 - Could the hit-enter prompt be avoided when a message only overlaps the |
2161 'showcmd' area? Clear that area when the next cmd is typed. | |
7 | 2162 8 When 'scrollbind' is set, a window won't scroll horizontally if the cursor |
2163 line is too short. Add a word in 'scrollopt' to allow moving the cursor | |
2164 to longer line that is visible. A similar thing is done for the GUI when | |
2165 using the horizontal scrollbar. | |
2166 7 VisVim can only open one file. Hard to solve: each opened file is passed | |
2167 with a separate invocation, would need to use timestamps to know the | |
2168 invocations belong together. | |
2169 8 When giving a ":bwipeout" command a file-changed dialog may popup for this | |
2170 buffer, which is pointless. (Mike Williams) | |
2171 8 On MS-Windows ":make" doesn't show output while it is working. Use the | |
2172 tee.exe from http://unxutils.sourceforge.net/ ? About 16 Kbyte in the | |
2173 UnxUtils.zip archive. | |
2174 Alternate one: http://www.pramodx.20m.com/tee_for_win32.htm, but Walter | |
2175 Briscoe says it's not as good. | |
819 | 2176 8 "stl" and "stlnc" in 'fillchars' don't work for multi-byte characters. |
844 | 2177 8 When doing Insert mode completion a mapping cannot recursively call |
2178 edit(), because the completion information is global. Put everything in | |
2179 an allocated structure? | |
1125 | 2180 6 Python: ":py raw_input('prompt')" doesn't work. (Manu Hack) |
7 | 2181 8 Command line completion: buffers "foo.txt" and "../b/foo.txt", completing |
2182 ":buf foo<Tab>" doesn't find the second one. (George V. Reilly) | |
2183 7 mb_off2cells() doesn't work correctly on the tail byte of a double-byte | |
2184 character. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto) It should return 1 when used on a tail | |
2185 byte, like for utf-8. Store second byte of double-byte in ScreenLines2[] | |
2186 (like for DBCS_JPNU) and put a zero in the second byte (like for UTF-8). | |
2187 8 'backupdir' and 'directory' should use $TMPDIR, $TMP and/or $TEMP when | |
2188 defined. | |
2189 7 Inside a function with "perl <<EOF" a line with "$i++" is recognized as an | |
2190 ":insert" command, causing the following "endfunction" not to be found. | |
2191 Add skipping this perl construction inside function definitions. | |
2192 7 When 'ttimeoutlen' is 10 and 'timeoutlen' is 1000, there is a keycode | |
2193 "<Esc>a" and a mapping <Esc>x", when typing "<Esc>a" with half a second | |
2194 delay should not be interpreted as a keycode. (Hans Ginzel) | |
2195 7 ":botright 1 new" twice causes all window heights to be changed. Make the | |
2196 bottom window only bigger as much as needed. | |
2197 7 The Cygwin and MingW makefiles define "PC", but it's not used anywhere. | |
2198 Remove? (Dan Sharp) | |
2199 9 User commands use the context of the script they were defined in. This | |
2200 causes a "s:var" argument to unexpectedly use a variable in the defining | |
2201 script, not the calling script. Add an argument to ":command": | |
2202 "-keepcontext". Do replace <SID>, so that a function in the defining | |
2203 script can be called. | |
2204 8 The Japanese message translations for MS-Windows are called ja.sjis.po, | |
2205 but they use encoding cp932. Rename the file and check that it still | |
2206 works. | |
2207 8 A very long message in confirm() can't be quit. Make this possible with | |
2208 CTRL-C. | |
237 | 2209 8 "gf" always excludes trailing punctuation characters. file_name_in_line() |
7 | 2210 is currently fixed to use ".,:;!". Add an option to make this |
2211 configurable? | |
2212 8 'hkmap' should probably be global-local. | |
2213 9 When "$" is in 'cpoptions' and folding is active, a "C" command changes | |
2214 the folds and resets w_lines_valid. The display updating doesn't work | |
2215 then. (Pritesh Mistry) | |
2216 8 Using ":s" in a function changes the previous replacement string. Save | |
2217 "old_sub" in save_search_patterns()? | |
1125 | 2218 8 Should allow multi-byte characters for the delimiter: ":s+a+b+" where "+" |
2219 is a multi-byte character. | |
7 | 2220 8 When appending to a file and 'patchmode' isn't empty, a backup file is |
2221 always written, even when the original file already exists. | |
2222 9 When getting focus while writing a large file, could warn for this file | |
2223 being changed outside of Vim. Avoid checking this while the file is being | |
2224 written. | |
2225 7 The message in bt_dontwrite_msg() could be clearer. | |
2226 8 The script ID that is stored with an option and displayed with ":verbose | |
2227 set" isn't reset when the option is set internally. For example when | |
2228 'foldlevel' is set from 'foldlevelstart'. | |
856 | 2229 8 Also store the line number with the script ID and use it for ":verbose", |
2230 so that "set nocompatible" is found when it changes other option values. | |
1125 | 2231 When an option is set indirectly mention the command? E.g. when |
2232 ":diffsplit" sets 'foldmethod'. | |
7 | 2233 8 In the fileformat dialog, "Cancel" isn't translated. Add a global |
2234 variable for this. (Eduardo Fernandez) | |
2235 9 When editing a file with 'readonly' set, there is no check for an existing | |
2236 swap file. Then using ":write" (without making any changes) doesn't give | |
2237 a warning either. Should check for an existing swap file without creating | |
1698 | 2238 one. Unfinished patch by Ian Kelling, 2008 July 14. |
7 | 2239 7 When 'showbreak' is set, the amount of space a Tab occupies changes. |
2240 Should work like 'showbreak' is inserted without changing the Tabs. | |
2241 7 When 'mousefocus' is set and switching to another window with a typed | |
2242 command, the mouse pointer may be moved to a part of the window that's | |
2243 covered by another window and we lose focus. Only move in the y | |
2244 direction, not horizontally? | |
2245 8 ":hardcopy": | |
2246 - Using the cterm_color[] table is wrong when t_colors is > 16. | |
2247 - Need to handle unprintable characters. | |
2248 - Win32: On a B&W printer syntax highlighting isn't visible. Perform | |
2249 dithering to make grey text? | |
2250 - Add a flag in 'printoptions' to add an empty page to make the total | |
2251 number even. "addempty"? (Mike Williams) | |
24 | 2252 - Respect 'linebreak'. Perhaps also 'showbreak'? |
2283
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2282
diff
changeset
|
2253 - Should interpret CTRL-L as a page break. |
7 | 2254 - Grey line numbers are not always readable. Add field in 'printoptions'. |
2255 Default to black when no syntax highlighting. | |
2256 - Be able to print a window in diff mode. | |
2257 - Be able to specify a colorscheme to use for printing. And a separate | |
2258 one for B&W printing (if that can be detected). | |
2259 8 In Visual block mode with 'lbr' set, a change command doesn't insert the | |
2260 text in following lines where the linebreak changes. | |
2261 9 dosinst.c: The DJGPP version can't uninstall the Uninstall registry key on | |
2262 Windows NT. How to install a .inf file on Windows NT and how to detect | |
2263 that Windows NT is being used? | |
2264 8 When 'virtualedit' is "block,insert" and encoding is "utf-8", selecting a | |
2265 block of one double-wide character, then "d" deletes only half of it. | |
2266 8 When 'virtualedit' is set, should "I" in blockwise visual mode also insert | |
2267 in lines that don't extend into the block? | |
2268 8 With 'virtualedit' set, in Insert mode just after the end of line, CTRL-O | |
2269 yh does not yank the last character of the line. (Pavel Papushev) | |
2270 Doing "hl" first appears to make it work. | |
2271 8 With 'virtualedit' set it's possible to move into the blank area from | |
2272 'linebreak'. | |
2273 8 With 'virtualedit' set and 'selection' "exclusive", a Visual selection | |
2274 that ends in or after a tab, "d" doesn't delete (part of) the tab. | |
2275 (Helmut Stiegler) | |
2276 9 When jumping to a tag, the search pattern is put in the history. When | |
2277 'magic' is on, the pattern may not work. Translate the pattern depending | |
2278 on p_magic when putting it in the history? Alternative: Store value of | |
2279 'magic' in history. (Margo) | |
2280 9 optwin.vim: Restoring a mapping for <Space> or <CR> is not correct for | |
2281 ":noremap". Add "mapcmd({string}, {mode})? Use code from ":mkexrc". | |
2282 9 incsearch is incorrect for "/that/<Return>/this/;//" (last search pattern | |
2283 isn't updated). | |
2284 9 term_console is used before it is set (msdos, Amiga). | |
2285 9 Get out-of-memory for ":g/^/,$s//@/" on 1000 lines, this is not handled | |
2286 correctly. Get many error messages while redrawing the screen, which | |
2287 cause another redraw, etc. | |
2288 8 [<C-I> doesn't work when '*' is in 'iskeyword'. find_pattern_in_path() | |
2289 must escape special characters in the pattern. | |
2290 8 Vim can overwrite a read-only file with ":w!". ":w" can't overwrite an | |
2291 existing file, "w!" can, but perhaps not a read-only file? Then use | |
2292 ":w!!" for that. | |
2293 Or ask for permission to overwrite it (if file can be made writable) and | |
2294 restore file to readonly afterwards. | |
460 | 2295 Overwriting a file for which a swap file exists is similar issue. |
7 | 2296 7 When compiled with "xterm_clipboard", startup can be slower and might get |
2297 error message for invalid $DISPLAY. Try connecting to the X server in the | |
2298 background (forked), so that Vim starts up quicker? Connect as soon as | |
2299 the clipboard is to be used (Visual select mode starts, paste from | |
2300 clipboard) | |
2301 7 X11: Some people prefer to use CLIPBOARD instead of PRIMARY for the normal | |
2302 selection. Add an "xclipboard" argument to the 'clipboard' option? (Mark | |
2303 Waggoner) | |
2304 8 For xterm need to open a connection to the X server to get the window | |
2305 title, which can be slow. Can also get the title with "<Esc>[21t", no | |
2306 need to use X11 calls. This returns "<Esc>]l{title}<Esc>\". | |
34 | 2307 6 When the xterm reports the number of colors, a redraw occurs. This is |
2308 annoying on a slow connection. Wait for the xterm to report the number of | |
2309 colors before drawing the screen. With a timeout. | |
7 | 2310 8 When the builtin xterm termcap contains codes that are not wanted, need a |
2311 way to avoid using the builtin termcap. | |
2312 8 Xterm sends ^[[H for <Home> and ^[[F for <End> in some mode. Also | |
2313 recognize these keys? Mostly useful for xterm simulators, like gnometerm. | |
2314 See http://dickey.his.com/xterm/xterm.faq.html#xterm_pc_style. | |
837 | 2315 8 For xterm also recognize keypad up/down/left/right and insert. |
7 | 2316 8 '[ and '] should be set to start/end of line when using a linewise operator |
2317 (e.g., ":w"). | |
2318 8 CTRL-A can't handle big "long" numbers, they become negative. Check for | |
2319 "-" character, if not present, use unsigned long. | |
2320 8 Make it possible to disable the special meaning of "#" in the first column | |
2321 for ">>". | |
2322 8 Add suspending with CTRL-Z at the "more" prompt, and when executing a long | |
2323 script in do_cmdline(). | |
2324 8 When using 'hidden', many swap files will be open. When Vim runs into the | |
2325 maximum number of open files, error messages will appear. Detect that | |
2326 this problem is present, and close any hidden files that don't have | |
2327 changes. | |
2328 8 With 'viminfo' set such that the ".viminfo" file is written on a FAT | |
2329 filesystem, an illegal file name may be created: ".vim". | |
2330 8 For each buffer that is opened, the viminfo file is opened and read to | |
2331 check for file marks. This can be slow. | |
2332 7 In xterm, recognize both vt100 and vt220 cursor keys. Change | |
2333 add_termcode() to not remove an existing entry for a name, when it's | |
2334 needed. | |
2335 Need a generic solution to recognize different codes for the same key. | |
2336 8 Core dump within signal function: gdb doesn't show stack backtrace! Option | |
2337 to skip catch_signals()? | |
2338 9 Repeating a "cw" with "." doesn't work if the text was pasted from the | |
2339 clipboard. (Thomas Jones) It's because the menu/toolbar item exits Insert | |
2340 mode and uses "gP". How to fix this without breaking inserting a block of | |
2341 text? | |
2342 8 In Replace mode pasting from the clipboard (using menu or toolbar) inserts | |
2343 all the text. Add ":rmenu"? | |
2344 8 Pasting with the mouse in Replace mode inserts the text, instead of | |
2345 overwriting, when it is more than one line. Same for using <C-R>. | |
2346 9 CTRL-E and CTRL-Y don't work in small window when 'so' is 4 and lines are | |
2347 wrapping (Acevedo/in.226). E.g., when using CTRL-E, window height 7, | |
2348 window might actually scroll down when last line of buffer is displayed. | |
2349 --> Remember if the previous command was "cursor follows screen" or | |
2350 "screen follow cursor" and use this in cursupdate(). | |
2351 7 tilde_replace() can only handle "~/", should also do "~user/". | |
2352 Get the list of home directories (from /etc/passwd? Use getpwent()) and | |
2353 use some clever algorithm to match a path with that. Find common strings | |
2354 in the list? | |
2355 8 When dragging status line with mouse, sometimes a jump when first clicking | |
2356 on the status line (caused by 'winheight'). Select window on button up, | |
2357 instead of on button down. | |
2358 8 Dragging the status line doesn't scroll but redraw. | |
2359 9 Evaluating 'statusline' in build_stl_str_hl() does not properly check for | |
2360 reaching the end of the available buffer. | |
1125 | 2361 Patch to dynamically allocate the buffer for % items. (Eric Arnold, 2006 |
2362 May 14) | |
7 | 2363 8 When performing incremental search, should abort searching as soon as a |
2364 character is typed. | |
2365 8 When the value of $MAKE contains a path, configure can't handle this. | |
2366 It's an autoconf bug. Remove the path from $MAKE to work around it. | |
2367 8 How to set VIMRC_FILE to \"something\" for configure? Why does this not | |
2368 work: CFLAGS='-DVIMRC_FILE=\"/mydir/myfile\"' ./configure | |
2369 8 The temporary file is sometimes not writable. Check for this, and use an | |
2370 alternate name when it isn't. Or add the 'temptemplate' option: template | |
2371 for the temp file name ":set temptemplate=/usr/tmp/?????.tmp". | |
2372 Also: Win32 version uses Windows temp directory, which might not work for | |
2373 cygwin bash. | |
2374 7 Get error "*, \+ or \( operand could be empty" for pattern "\(.\)\1\{3}". | |
2375 Remember flags for backreferences. | |
2376 7 When switching to Daylight Saving Time, Vim complains that a file has been | |
2377 changed since last read. Can we use a function that uses GMT? | |
2378 7 When completing an environment variable after a '$', check for file names | |
2379 that contain a '$' after all have been found. | |
2380 8 When "cm" termcap entry is missing, starting gvim shouldn't complain about | |
2381 it. (Lohner) Try out with "vt100" entry, cm replaced with cX. | |
2382 7 When an include file starts with "../", the check for already visiting | |
2383 this file doesn't work. Need to simplify the file name. | |
2384 7 The names and comments for the arguments of do_browse() are confusing. | |
2385 "dflt" isn't the default file name when "initdir" is not NULL and | |
2386 "initdir" is the default path to be used. | |
2387 7 When 'scrolloff' is exactly half the window height, "j" causes a scroll of | |
2388 two lines at a time. "k" doesn't do this. (Cory T. Echols) | |
2389 8 When write_viminfo() is used while there are many orphaned viminfo | |
2390 tempfiles writing the viminfo file fails. Give a clear error message so | |
2391 that the user knows he has to delete the files. | |
2392 7 It's possible to redefine a script-local function with ":func | |
2393 <SNR>123_Test()". (Krishna) Disallow this. | |
2394 | |
2395 | |
2396 I can't reproduce these (if you can, let me know how!): | |
2397 9 NT 4.0 on NTFS file system: Editing ".bashrc" (drag and drop), file | |
2398 disappears. Editing ".xyz" is OK. Also, drag&drop only works for three | |
2399 files. (McCollister) | |
2400 | |
2401 | |
2402 Problems that will (probably) not be solved: | |
835 | 2403 - GTK: when using the popup menu with spelling suggestions and releasing the |
2404 right mouse button before the menu appears selecting an item with the | |
2405 right mouse button has no effect. GTK does not produce an event for this. | |
1698 | 2406 - GTK 2: Cannot use the file selector. When using it many things become |
2407 slow. This is caused by some code in GTK that writes | |
2408 ~/.recently-used.xbel every time an event is handled. It assumes the main | |
2409 loop is never quit, which is a wrong assumption. Also, it overwrites the | |
2410 file with different file permissions, which is a privacy issue. This | |
2411 needs to be fixed in GTK. A solution in Vim would be really complicated. | |
2502
e6420d275b6a
Update README files. Remove references to extra and lang archives.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2495
diff
changeset
|
2412 (2008 Jul 31) This appears to be fixed in Vim 7.3. |
34 | 2413 - xterm title: The following scenario may occur (esp. when running the Vim |
2414 test script): Vim 1 sets the title to "file1", then restores the title to | |
162 | 2415 "xterm" with an ESC sequence when exiting. Vim 2 obtains the old title |
34 | 2416 with an X library call, this may result in "file1", because the window |
2417 manager hasn't processed the "xterm" title yet. Can apparently only be | |
2418 worked around with a delay. | |
7 | 2419 - In a terminal with 'mouse' set such that the mouse is active when entering |
2420 a command line, after executing a shell command that scrolls up the | |
2421 display and then pressing ":": Selecting text with the mouse works like | |
2422 the display wasn't scrolled. Vim doesn't know how much the external | |
2423 command scrolled up the display. Use Shift to select text. | |
2424 - X windows: When $DISPLAY points to a X server where there is no access | |
2425 permission, trying to connect to the X server causes an error message. | |
2426 XtOpenDisplay() prints this directly, there is no way to avoid it. | |
2427 - X windows: Setting 'guifontset' to an illegal value sometimes crashes Vim. | |
2428 This is caused by a fault in a X library function, can't be solved in Vim. | |
1125 | 2429 - Win32 tcl: has("tcl") hangs when the tcl84.dll is from cygwin. |
7 | 2430 - Motif: When adding a menu item "Find this &Symbol", the "s" in "this" will |
2431 be underlined, instead of in "Symbol". Motif doesn't let us specify which | |
2432 character gets the highlighting. | |
2433 - Moving the cursor removes color in color-xterm. This is a color-xterm | |
2434 problem! color-xterm ver. 6.1 beta 3 and later work properly. | |
2435 - In zsh, "gvim&" changes the terminal settings. This is a zsh problem. | |
2436 (Jennings) | |
2437 - Problem with HPterm under X: old contents of window is lost (Cosentino). | |
2438 - Amiga: When using quickfix with the Manx compiler we only get the first 25 | |
2439 errors. How do we get the rest? | |
2440 - Amiga: The ":cq" command does not always abort the Manx compiler. Why? | |
237 | 2441 - Linux: A file with protection r--rw-rw- is seen readonly for others. The |
7 | 2442 access() function in GNU libc is probably wrong. |
2443 - MSDOS: When using smartdrive with write-back buffering, writing to a | |
2444 readonly floppy will cause problems. How to test for a writable floppy | |
2445 first? | |
2446 - MSDOS: Both 16 and 32 bit versions: File name expansion doesn't work for | |
2447 names that start with a dot. These used to be illegal file names. | |
2448 - When doing a CTRL-Z and typing a command for the shell, while Vim is busy | |
2449 (e.g. writing a file), the command for the shell is sometimes eaten by Vim, | |
2450 because the terminal mode is changed from RAW to CBREAK. | |
2451 - An old version of GNU tgoto can't handle the terminfo code for "AF". The | |
2452 "%p1" is interpreted as "%p" and "1", causing color not to be working. | |
2453 Fix: Change the "%p1" in the "AF" and "AB" terminfo entries to "%p". | |
2454 (Benzinger). | |
2455 - When running an external command from the GUI, typeahead is going to that | |
2456 program, not to Vim. It looks like the shell eats the characters, Vim | |
2457 can't get back what the external command didn't use. | |
2458 - Win32 GUI: Error code from external command not returned in shell_error. | |
2459 It appears that cmd.exe and command.com don't return an error code. | |
2460 - Win32 GUI: The Toolbar is a bit too high when the flat style is being | |
2461 used. We don't have control over the height of the Toolbar. | |
2462 - Win32: All files created on the day of switching from winter to summer | |
2463 time cause "changed since editing started" messages. It goes away when | |
2464 the file is written again the next day, or the timezone is adjusted. | |
2465 DJGPP version is OK. (Zaimi) Looks like a problem with the Win32 library. | |
2466 Rebooting doesn't help. Time stamps look OK in directory. (Penn) | |
2467 Is this on FAT (stores wall clock time) or NTFS (stores UTS)? | |
2468 - Win32, MS-Windows XP: $HOME uses the wrong drive when the user profiles | |
2469 are not on the boot disk. This is caused by a wrong value of $HOMEDRIVE. | |
2470 This is a bug in XP, see MSKB article 818134. | |
2725 | 2471 - Win32, MS-Windows: expanding plugin/**/*.vim also picks up |
2472 dir/ctags.vim,v. This is because the short file name is something like | |
2473 "ctags~1.vim" and that matches the pattern. | |
7 | 2474 - SunOS 5.5.1 with Motif: The file open dialog does not have a horizontal |
2475 scroll bar for the "files" selection. This is a problem in the Motif | |
2476 libraries, get a patch from Sun. | |
2477 - Solaris 2.6 with GTK and Perl: gvim crashes when started. Problem with X | |
2478 input method called from GDK code. Without Perl it doesn't crash. | |
2479 - VMS: Vimdiff doesn't work with the VMS diff, because the output looks | |
2480 different. This makes test 47 fail. Install a Unix-compatible diff. | |
2481 - VMS v7.1 and older: Tests 21 and 32 fail. From VMS v7.1-2 and newer Vim | |
2482 does not have this behavior. (Zoltan Arpadffy) | |
2483 - Win32 GUI: mouse wheel always scrolls rightmost window. The events arrive | |
2484 in Vim as if the rightmost scrollbar was used. | |
2485 - GTK with Gnome: Produces an error message when starting up: | |
2486 Gdk-WARNING **: locale not supported by C library | |
2487 This is caused by the gnome library gnome_init() setting $LC_CTYPE to | |
2488 "en_US". Not all systems support this locale name, thus causing the | |
2489 error. Hopefully a newer version of GTK/Gnome fixes this problem. | |
2490 - GTK 2: With this mapping the hit-enter prompt is _sometimes_ below the | |
2491 screen, at other times there is a grey area below the command line: | |
2492 :nmap <F11> :if &guioptions=~'m' \| set guioptions-=m \| else \| set guioptions+=m \| endif<cr> | |
2493 - GTK: When pasting a selection from Vim to xclipboard gvim crashes with a | |
2494 ABRT signal. Probably an error in the file gdkselection.c, the assert | |
2495 always fails when XmbTextListToTextProperty() fails. (Tom Allard) | |
10 | 2496 - GTK 2: gives an assertion error for every non-builtin icon in the toolbar. |
2497 This is a GTK 2.4.x bug, fixed in GTK 2.4.2. (Thomas de Grenier de Latour) | |
7 | 2498 - When using an xterm that supports the termresponse feature, and the 't_Co' |
2499 termcap option was wrong when Vim started, it will be corrected when the | |
2500 termresponse is received. Since the number of colors changes, the | |
2501 highlighting needs to be initialized again. This may cause colors defined | |
2502 in the vimrc file to be lost. | |
2503 - On Windows NT 4.0 the number of files passed to Vim with drag&drop and | |
2504 "Edit with Vim" is limited. The maximum command line length is 255 chars. | |
2505 | |
2506 --------------------- extensions and improvements ---------------------- | |
2507 *extensions-improvements* | |
2508 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2509 Most interesting new features to be added when all bugs have been fixed: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2510 - Using ":exe edit fname" has escaping problems. Use ":edit ++(fname)". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2511 Thus use "++=" to give arguments as expressions, comma separated as if |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2512 calling a function. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2513 With options: ":edit ++(['!', '++enc=abc'], ['+/pat'], fname)". |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2514 Alternative: Make a function for Ex commands: cmd_edit(). |
713 | 2515 - Add COLUMN NUMBERS to ":" commands ":line1,line2[col1,col2]cmd". Block |
2516 can be selected with CTRL-V. Allow '$' (end of line) for col2. | |
2517 - Add DEBUGGER INTERFACE. Implementation for gdb by Xavier de Gaye. | |
2518 Should work like an IDE. Try to keep it generic. Now found here: | |
2519 http://clewn.sf.net. | |
2520 And the idevim plugin/script. | |
2521 To be able to start the debugger from inside Vim: For GUI run a program | |
2522 with a netbeans connection; for console: start a program that splits the | |
2523 terminal, runs the debugger in one window and reconnect Vim I/O to the | |
2524 other window. | |
2525 Wishes for NetBeans commands: | |
2526 - make it possible to have 'defineAnnoType' also handle terminal colors. | |
2527 - send 'balloonText' events for the cursor position (using CursorHold ?) | |
2528 in terminal mode. | |
2529 - ECLIPSE plugin. Problem is: the interface is very complicated. Need to | |
2530 implement part in Java and then connect to Vim. Some hints from Alexandru | |
2531 Roman, 2004 Dec 15. Should then also work with Oracle Jdeveloper, see JSR | |
2532 198 standard http://www.jcp.org/en/jsr/detail?id=198. | |
2533 Eclim does it: http://eclim.sourceforge.net/ (Eric Van Dewoestine) | |
2534 Plugin that uses a terminal emulator: http://vimplugin.sf.net | |
1125 | 2535 And another one: http://www.satokar.com/viplugin/index.php |
713 | 2536 - STICKY CURSOR: Add a way of scrolling that leaves the cursor where it is. |
2537 Especially when using the scrollbar. Typing a cursor-movement command | |
2538 scrolls back to where the cursor is. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2539 - Scroll commands by screen line. g CTRL-E and g CTRL-Y ? Requires the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
2540 first line to be able to start halfway. |
713 | 2541 - Running a shell command from the GUI still has limitations. Look into how |
2542 the terminal emulator of the Vim shell project can help: | |
2543 http://vimshell.wana.at | |
2544 8 Add a command to jump to a certain kind of tag. Allow the user to specify | |
2545 values for the optional fields. E.g., ":tag size type=m". | |
2546 Also allow specifying the file and command, so that the result of | |
2547 taglist() can be used. | |
769 | 2548 - X11: Make it possible to run Vim inside a window of another program. |
2549 This can be done with XReparentWindow(). But how exactly? | |
713 | 2550 |
2551 | |
7 | 2552 Documentation: |
1125 | 2553 8 List of Vim runtime directories. dotvim.txt from Charles Campbell, 2007 |
2554 Feb 20. | |
36 | 2555 8 The GUI help should explain the Find and Find/Replace dialogs. Add a link |
2556 to it from ":promptrepl" and ":promptfind". | |
22 | 2557 8 List of options should mention whether environment variables are expanded |
2558 or not. | |
7 | 2559 8 Extend usr_27.txt a bit. (Adam Seyfarth) |
2560 7 Add a section on debugging scripts in the user manual. | |
2561 9 Make the Reference Manual more precise. For each command mention: | |
2562 - change to cursor position and curswant | |
2563 - if it can be undone (u/CTRL-R) and redone (.) | |
2564 - how it works for folded lines | |
2565 - how it works with multi-byte characters | |
2566 9 In change.txt, remark about Javadoc isn't right. Right alignment would | |
2567 work too. | |
2568 8 Spread the windows commands over the other files. For example, ":stag" | |
2569 should be with ":tag". Cross-link with tags to avoid too much double | |
2570 text. | |
2571 8 Add tags for all features, e.g. "gui_running". | |
2572 7 MS-Windows: When a wrong command is typed with an ALT key, give a hint to | |
2573 look at the help for 'winaltkeys'. | |
2574 7 Add a help.vim plugin that maps <Tab> to jump to the next tag in || and | |
2575 <C-Tab> (and <S-Tab>) to the previous tag. | |
1624 | 2576 Patch by Balazs Kezes, 2007 Dec 30. Remark from A. Politz. |
7 | 2577 - Check text editor compendium for vi and Vim remarks. |
2578 | |
2579 | |
2580 Help: | |
2581 - First try using the ":help" argument literally, before using it as a | |
2582 pattern. And then match it as part of a tag. | |
2583 - When a help item has multiple matches make it possible to use ":tn" to go | |
2584 to the other matches. | |
2585 - Support a way to view (and edit) .info files. | |
2586 - Default mapping for help files: <Tab> to position cursor on next |:tag|. | |
2587 - Implement a "sticky" help window, some help text lines that are always | |
2588 displayed in a window with fixed height. (Guckes) Use "~/.vimhelp" file, | |
2589 user can edit it to insert his favorite commands, new account can contain a | |
2590 default contents. | |
2591 - Make 'winminheight' a local option, so that the user can set a minimal | |
2592 height for the help window (and other windows). | |
2593 - ":help :s^I" should expand to ":help :substitute". | |
2594 - Make the help key (<F1>) context sensitive? | |
2595 - Learn mode: show short help while typing commands. | |
2596 | |
2597 | |
2598 User Friendlier: | |
2599 8 Windows install with install.exe: Use .exe instead of .bat files for | |
2600 links, so that command line arguments are passed on unmodified? (Walter | |
2601 Briscoe) | |
2602 8 Windows install: Be able to associate Vim with a selection of file types? | |
2603 8 Windows uninstall: Have uninstal.c delete the vimfiles directories that | |
2604 dosinst.c creates. List the contents of the directory (recursively) if | |
2605 the user asks for it. Requires an implementation of "rm -rf". | |
2606 8 Remember the name of the vimrc file that was used (~/.vimrc, $VIM/_vimrc, | |
2607 $HOME/_vimrc, etc.) and add "edit vimrc" to the File menu. | |
2608 - Add a way to save local settings and mappings into a new plugin file. | |
2609 ":mkplugin <file>"? | |
2610 8 Add ":plugininstall" command. Can be used to install a plugin file that | |
2611 includes documentation. Let the user select a directory from | |
2612 'runtimepath'. | |
2613 " Vim plugin | |
2614 <main plugin code> | |
2615 " >>> plugin help start <<< | |
2616 <plugin docs> | |
2617 - Add mappings local to a window: ":map <window> ..."? | |
2618 9 Add buffer-local menu. Should offer a choice between removing the menu or | |
2619 disabling it. Be careful that tear-offs don't disappear (keep one empty | |
2620 item?). | |
2621 Alternative: use BufEnter and BufLeave autocommands. | |
2622 8 make a vimtutor script for Amiga and other systems. | |
2623 7 Add the arguments for configure to the ":version" output? | |
387 | 2624 7 When Vim detects a file is being edited elsewhere and it's a gvim session |
2625 of the same user it should offer a "Raise" button, so that the other gvim | |
2626 window can be displayed. (Eduard) | |
640 | 2627 8 Support saving and restoring session for X windows? It should work to do |
2628 ":mksession" and use "-S fname" for the restart command. The | |
2629 gui_x11_wm_protocol_handler() already takes care of the rest. | |
2630 global_event_filter() for GTK. | |
7 | 2631 |
2632 | |
693 | 2633 Tab pages: |
2634 9 GUI implementation for the tab pages line for other systems. | |
1125 | 2635 7 GUI: Control over the appearance of the text in the labels (bold, color, |
2636 font, etc.) | |
693 | 2637 8 Make GUI menu in tab pages line configurable. Like the popup menu. |
838 | 2638 8 balloons for the tab page labels that are shortened to show the full path. |
693 | 2639 8 :tabmove +N move tab page N pages forward |
2640 8 :tabmove -N move tab page N pages backward | |
2641 7 :tabdup duplicate the tab with all its windows. | |
2642 7 Option to put tab line at the left or right? Need an option to specify | |
1226 | 2643 its width. It's like a separate window with ":tabs" output. |
693 | 2644 7 Add local variables for each tab page? |
2645 8 Add local options for each tab page? E.g., 'diffopt' could differ between | |
2646 tab pages. | |
2647 7 Add local highlighting for each tab page? | |
1125 | 2648 7 Add local directory for tab pages? How would this interfere with |
2649 window-local directories? | |
693 | 2650 |
2651 | |
388 | 2652 Spell checking: |
1668 | 2653 - have some way not to give spelling errors for a range of characters. |
2654 E.g. for Chinese and other languages with specific characters for which we | |
2655 don't have a spell file. Useful when there is also text in other | |
2656 languages in the file. | |
1125 | 2657 - Support more regions? Caolan McNamara argues it's needed for es_XX. |
2658 https://bugzilla.redhat.com/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=219777 | |
2659 - Unicode defines another quote character: 0x2019. Use it as an equivalent | |
2660 of a single quote, thus use it as a word character like a quote and match | |
2661 with words, replacing the curly quote with a single quote. | |
2662 - Could filter é things for HTML before doing spell checking. | |
2663 Similarly for TeX. | |
860 | 2664 - The Hungarian spell file uses four extra characters in the FOL/UPP/LOW |
2665 items than other spell files with the ISO-8859-2 encoding, that causes | |
2666 problem when changing 'spelllang'. There is no obvious way to fix this. | |
827 | 2667 - Considering Hunspell 1.1.4: |
2668 What does MAXNGRAMSUGS do? | |
2669 Is COMPLEXPREFIXES necessary when we have flags for affixes? | |
1624 | 2670 - Support spelling words in CamelCase as if they were two separate words. |
2671 Requires some option to enable it. (Timothy Knox) | |
2072 | 2672 - There is no Finnish spell checking file. For openoffice Voikko is now |
1125 | 2673 used, which is based on Malaga: http://home.arcor.de/bjoern-beutel/malaga/ |
2674 (Teemu Likonen) | |
827 | 2675 8 ":mkspell" still takes much too long in Hungarian dictionary from |
2676 hunspell. Only solution appears to be to postpone secondary suffixes. | |
2677 8 Handle postponed prefix with COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG or COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG. | |
2678 WFP_COMPPERMIT and WFP_COMPFORBID | |
2679 8 implement use of <compoptions> in .spl file: | |
2680 implement CHECKCOMPOUNDREP: when a compound word seems to be OK apply REP | |
1668 | 2681 items and check if the result is a valid word. |
827 | 2682 implement CHECKCOMPOUNDDUP |
2683 implement CHECKCOMPOUNDTRIPLE | |
2684 Add CHECKCOMPOUNDCASE: when compounding make leading capital lower case. | |
2685 How is it supposed to work? | |
819 | 2686 - Add a command the repeats ]s and z=, showing the misspelled word in its |
2687 context. Thus to spell-check a whole file. | |
700 | 2688 - suggestion for "KG" to "kg" when it's keepcase. |
821 | 2689 - For flags on affixes: Use a "AFFCOMPSET" flag; means the compound flags of |
2690 the word are not used. | |
798 | 2691 - Support breakpoint character ? 0xb7 and ignore it? Makes it possible to |
713 | 2692 use same wordlist for hyphenation. |
809 | 2693 - Compound word is accepted if nr of words is <= COMPOUNDWORDMAX OR nr of |
501 | 2694 syllables <= COMPOUNDSYLMAX. Specify using AND in the affix file? |
625 | 2695 - NEEDCOMPOUND also used for affix? Or is this called ONLYINCOMPOUND now? |
2696 Or is ONLYINCOMPOUND only for inside a compound, not at start or end? | |
501 | 2697 - Do we need a flag for the rule that when compounding is done the following |
2698 word doesn't have a capital after a word character, even for Onecap words? | |
2699 - New hunspell home page: http://hunspell.sourceforge.net/ | |
538 | 2700 - Version 1.1.0 is out now, look into that. |
501 | 2701 - Lots of code depends on LANG, that isn't right. Enable each mechanism |
2702 in the affix file separately. | |
2703 - Example with compounding dash is bad, gets in the way of setting | |
809 | 2704 COMPOUNDMIN and COMPOUNDWORDMAX to a reasonable value. |
501 | 2705 - PSEUDOROOT == NEEDAFFIX |
2706 - COMPOUNDROOT -> COMPOUNDED? For a word that already is a compound word | |
2707 Or use COMPOUNDED2, COMPOUNDED3, etc. | |
2708 - CIRCUMFIX: when a word uses a prefix marked with the CIRCUMFIX flag, then | |
2709 the word must also have a suffix marked with the CIRCUMFIX flag. It's a | |
2710 bit primitive, since only one flag is used, which doesn't allow matching | |
2711 specific prefixes with suffixes. | |
2712 Alternative: | |
2713 PSFX {flag} {pchop} {padd} {pcond} {schop} {sadd}[/flags] {scond} | |
2714 We might not need this at all, you can use the NEEDAFFIX flag and the | |
2715 affix which is required. | |
2716 - When a suffix has more than one syllable, it may count as a word for | |
809 | 2717 COMPOUNDWORDMAX. |
501 | 2718 - Add flags to count extra syllables in a word. SYLLABLEADD1 SYLLABLEADD2, |
2719 etc.? Or make it possible to specify the syllable count of a word | |
2720 directly, e.g., after another slash: /abc/3 | |
625 | 2721 - MORPHO item in affix file: ignore TAB and morphological field after |
2722 word/flags and affix. | |
501 | 2723 - Implement multiple flags for compound words and CMP item? |
2724 Await comments from other spell checking authors. | |
2725 - Also see tklspell: http://tkltrans.sourceforge.net/ | |
388 | 2726 8 Charles Campbell asks for method to add "contained" groups to existing |
2727 syntax items (to add @Spell). | |
2728 Add ":syntax contains {pattern} add=@Spell" command? A bit like ":syn | |
2729 cluster" but change the contains list directly for matching syntax items. | |
2730 - References: MySpell library (in OpenOffice.org). | |
2731 http://spellchecker.mozdev.org/source.html | |
2732 http://whiteboard.openoffice.org/source/browse/whiteboard/lingucomponent/source/spellcheck/myspell/ | |
2733 author: Kevin Hendricks <kevin.hendricks@sympatico.ca> | |
1624 | 2734 8 It is currently not possible to mark "can not" as rare, because "can" and |
2735 "not" are good words. Find a way to let "rare" overrule "good"? | |
388 | 2736 8 Make "en-rare" spell file? Ask Charles Campbell. |
2737 8 The English dictionaries for different regions are not consistent in their | |
2738 use of words with a dash. | |
2739 7 Insert mode completion mechanism that uses the spell word lists. | |
2740 8 Add hl groups to 'spelllang'? | |
2741 :set spelllang=en_us,en-rare/SpellRare,en-math/SpellMath | |
2742 More complicated: Regions with different languages? E.g., comments | |
2743 in English, strings in German (po file). | |
2744 | |
2745 | |
7 | 2746 Diff mode: |
1624 | 2747 9 Instead invoking an external diff program, use builtin code. One can be |
2748 found here: http://www.ioplex.com/~miallen/libmba/dl/src/diff.c | |
2348
8878a9f8db87
Rename w_p_conceal to w_p_conc for consistency.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2345
diff
changeset
|
2749 It's quite big and badly documented though. |
7 | 2750 8 Use diff mode to show the changes made in a buffer (compared to the file). |
2751 Use an unnamed buffer, like doing: | |
2752 new | set bt=nofile | r # | 0d_ | diffthis | wincmd p | diffthis | |
557 | 2753 Also show difference with the file when editing started? Should show what |
2754 can be undone. (Tom Popovich) | |
7 | 2755 7 Add cursor-binding: when moving the cursor in one diff'ed buffer, also |
2756 move it in other diff'ed buffers, so that CTRL-W commands go to the same | |
2757 location. | |
2758 | |
2759 | |
2760 Folding: | |
569 | 2761 (commands still available: zI zJ zK zp zP zq zQ zV zy zY; |
2762 secondary: zB zS zT zZ, z=) | |
1125 | 2763 8 Vertical folds: looks like vertically split windows, but the cursor moves |
2764 through the vertical separator, separator moves when scrolling. | |
40 | 2765 8 Add "z/" and "z?" for searching in not folded text only. |
1125 | 2766 9 Add search pattern item to only match in closed or open fold and/or fold |
2767 with certain level. Allows doing ":g/pat/cmd" to work on closed folds. | |
7 | 2768 8 When a closed fold is displayed open because of 'foldminlines', the |
2769 behavior of commands is still like the fold is closed. How to make the | |
2770 user aware of this? | |
2771 8 Add an option 'foldskip' with values like 'foldopen' that specifies which | |
2772 commands skip over a closed fold. | |
2773 8 "H" and "L" count buffer lines instead of window lines. (Servatius Brandt) | |
2774 8 Add a way to add fold-plugins. Johannes Zellner has one for VB. | |
2775 7 When using manual folding, the undo command should also restore folds. | |
36 | 2776 - Allow completely hiding a closed fold. E.g., by setting 'foldtext' to an |
2777 empty string. Require showing a character in 'foldcolumn' to avoid the | |
2778 missing line goes unnoticed. | |
2779 How to implement this? | |
7 | 2780 - When pressing the down arrow of a scrollbar, a closed fold doesn't scroll |
2781 until after a long time. How to make scrolling with closed folds | |
2782 smoother? | |
2783 - When creating a session, also store folds for buffers in the buffer list, | |
2784 using the wininfo in wi_folds. | |
860 | 2785 - When currently editing the first file in the argument list the session |
2786 file can contain: | |
2787 args version.c main.c | |
2788 edit version.c | |
2789 Can editing version.c twice be avoided? | |
7 | 2790 - 'foldmethod' "textobject": fold on sections and paragraph text objects. |
625 | 2791 - "zuf": undo change in manual fold. "zUf" redo change in manual fold. How |
2792 to implement this? | |
7 | 2793 - "zJ" command: add the line or fold below the fold in the fold under the |
2794 cursor. | |
708 | 2795 - 'foldmethod' "syntax": "fold=3" argument: set fold level for a region or |
2796 match. | |
7 | 2797 - Apply a new foldlevel to a range of lines. (Steve Litt) |
36 | 2798 8 Have some way to restrict commands to not folded text. Also commands like |
7 | 2799 searches. |
2800 | |
2801 | |
2802 Multi-byte characters: | |
713 | 2803 - When editing a file with both utf-8 and latin1 text Vim always falls back |
2804 to latin1. Add a command to convert the latin1 characters to utf-8? | |
2805 :unmix utf-8,latin1 filename | |
2806 Would only work when 'encoding' is utf-8. | |
7 | 2807 9 When the tail byte of a double-byte character is illegal (e.g., a CR), the |
2808 display is messed up (Yasuhiro Matsumoto). Should check for illegal | |
2809 double-byte characters and display them differently (display each single | |
2810 byte). | |
2400
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2398
diff
changeset
|
2811 9 'fenc' in modeline problem: add option to reload the file when 'fenc' is |
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2398
diff
changeset
|
2812 set to a different value in a modeline? Option can be default on. Could |
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2398
diff
changeset
|
2813 it be done with an autocommand? |
7 | 2814 8 Add an item in 'fileencodings' to check the first lines of a file for |
2815 the encoding. See Python PEP: http://www.python.org/peps/pep-0263.html. | |
2816 To avoid getting a wrong encoding only accept something Emacs-like: | |
2817 "-*- coding: enc-na_me.foo -*-" and "-*- coding= enc-na_me.foo -*-" | |
2818 Match with "-\*-\s*coding[:=]\s*\([::word::-_.]\+\)\s*-\*-" and use first | |
2819 item. | |
2820 8 Add an item in 'fileencodings' to check the first line of an XML file for | |
237 | 2821 the encoding. <?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?> Or "charset=UTF-8"? |
2822 For HTML look for "charset=utf-8". | |
7 | 2823 8 The quickfix file is read without conversion, thus in 'encoding'. Add an |
2824 option to specify the encoding of the errorfile and convert it. Also for | |
36 | 2825 ":grep" and ":helpgrep". |
38 | 2826 More generic solution: support a filter (e.g., by calling a function). |
7 | 2827 8 When a file was converted from 'fileencoding' to 'encoding', a tag search |
2828 should also do this on the search pattern. (Andrzej M. Ostruszka) | |
1624 | 2829 8 When filtering changes the encoding 'fileencoding' may not work. E.g., |
2830 when using xxd and 'fileencoding' is "utf-16". Add an option to set a | |
2831 different fileencoding for filter output? | |
7 | 2832 7 When converting a file fails, mention which byte could not be converted, |
2833 so that the user can fix the problem. | |
2834 8 Add configure option to be able to disable using the iconv library. (Udo | |
2835 Schweigert) | |
2836 9 'aleph' should be set to 1488 for Unicode. (Zvi Har'El) | |
2837 8 Should add test for using various commands with multi-byte characters. | |
2838 8 'infercase' doesn't work with multi-byte characters. | |
2839 8 toupper() function doesn't handle byte count changes. | |
1624 | 2840 7 Searching and composing characters: |
2841 When searching, should order of composing characters be ignored? | |
2842 Add special item to match with a composing character, zero-width, so that | |
2843 one can replace a base character and keep the composing characters. | |
2844 Add a special item to match with a composing character, so that composing | |
2845 characters can be manipulated. | |
2846 Add a modifier to ignore composing characters, only compare base | |
2847 characters. Useful for Hebrew (Ron Aaron) | |
7 | 2848 8 Should implement 'delcombine' for command line editing. |
2849 8 Detect overlong UTF-8 sequences and handle them like illegal bytes. | |
2850 8 ":s/x/\u\1/" doesn't work, making uppercase isn't done for multi-byte | |
2851 characters. | |
2852 8 UTF-8: "r" in Visual mode doesn't take composing characters. | |
2853 8 UTF-8: When there is a precomposed character in the font, use it instead | |
2854 of a character and a composing character. See xterm for an example. | |
2855 7 When a character can't be displayed, display its digraph instead. | |
2856 'display' option to specify this. | |
2857 7 Use ideas for nl_langinfo() from Markus Kuhn in enc_default(): | |
2858 (www.cl.cam.ac.uk/~mgk25/ucs/langinfo.c) | |
2859 - GTK and Win32: Allow selecting fonts for 'guifontset' with the | |
2860 fontselector somehow. | |
2861 - GTK and Win32: make it possible to set the font for the menu to make it | |
2862 possible to have 'encoding' different from the current locale. | |
2863 - dbcs_class() only works for Japanese and Korean. Implement this for | |
2864 other encodings. The "euc-jp" and "euc-kr" choices might be wrong. | |
2865 - Find some way to automatically select the right GUI font or fontset, | |
2866 depending on the default value of 'encoding'. | |
2867 Irrelevant in the GTK+ 2 GUI so long as UTF-8 is used. | |
2868 For Windows, the charset_pairs[] table could be used. But how do we know | |
2869 if a font exists? | |
2870 - Do keyboard conversion from 'termencoding' to 'encoding' with | |
2826 | 2871 convert_input() for Mac GUI. |
7 | 2872 - Add mnemonics from RFC1345 longer than two characters. |
2873 Support CTRL-K _{mnemonic}_ | |
2874 7 In "-- INSERT (lang) --" show the name of the keymap used instead of | |
2875 "lang". (Ilya Dogolazky) | |
500 | 2876 - Make 'breakat' accept multi-byte characters. Problem: can't use a lookup |
2877 table anymore (breakat_flags[]). | |
2878 Simplistic solution: when 'formatoptions' contains "m" also break a line | |
2879 at a multi-byte character >= 0x100. | |
7 | 2880 - Add the possibility to enter mappings which are used whenever normal text |
2881 could be entered. E.g., for "f" command. But not in Normal mode. Sort | |
2882 of opposite of 'langmap'. Use ":tmap" command? | |
2883 - When breaking a line, take properties of multi-byte characters into | |
2884 account. The "linebreak" program from Bruno Haible can do it: | |
2885 ftp://ftp.ilog.fr/pub/Users/haible/gnu/linebreak-0.1.tar.gz | |
2886 But it's very complicated... | |
2887 | |
2888 | |
2889 Printing: | |
218 | 2890 7 Implement "undercurl" for printing. |
7 | 2891 - Add "page width" to wrap long lines. |
2892 - Win32: use a font dialog for setting 'printfont'. Can reuse the code for | |
2893 the 'guifont' dialog, put the common code in a separate function. | |
46 | 2894 - Add the file timestamp to the page header (with an option). (George |
2895 Reilly) | |
7 | 2896 - Win32: when 'printfont' is empty use 'guifont'. |
2897 - Unix: Use some dialog box to do the obvious settings (paper size, printer | |
2898 name, portrait/landscape, etc). | |
1125 | 2899 - PostScript: Only works for text that can be converted to an 8-bit |
2900 character set. How to support Unicode fully? | |
7 | 2901 - Allow specifying the paper size, instead of using a standard size. Same |
2902 units as for the margins. | |
2903 - Support right-to-left text? | |
2904 8 Make the foreground color darkening function preserve the hue of the | |
2905 color. | |
2906 | |
2907 | |
2908 Syntax highlighting: | |
2909 8 Make ":syn off" use 'runtimepath' instead of $VIMRUNTIME. (Gary Johnson) | |
2910 Should do the same for ":syn on" and ":syn manual". | |
2911 8 Support "containedin" argument for ":syn include", so that the defined | |
2912 cluster can be added to existing syntax items. | |
2913 8 C syntax: Don't highlight {} as errors inside () when used like this: | |
2914 "({ something })", often used in GCC code. | |
819 | 2915 7 Add a "startgroup" to a region. Used like "nextgroup" inside the region, |
2916 preferred item at the start of the region. (Charles Campbell) | |
7 | 2917 8 When editing a new file without a name and giving it a name (by writing |
2918 it) and 'filetype' is not set, detect the filetype. Avoid doing it for | |
2919 ":wq file". | |
1125 | 2920 7 For "nextgroup" we have skipwhite, skipnl and skipempty. It would be |
2921 really nice to be able to skip with a pattern. Or skip with a syntax | |
2922 group. (Nikolai Weibull, 2007 Feb 27) | |
7 | 2923 8 Make conversion to HTML faster (Write it in C or pre-compile the script). |
2924 9 There is still a redraw bug somewhere. Probably because a cached state is | |
2925 used in a wrong way. I can't reproduce it... | |
2926 7 Be able to change only the background highlighting. Useful for Diff* and | |
2927 Search highlighting. | |
747 | 2928 7 When 'number' is set highlight the number of the current line. |
2929 Must be enabled with an option, because it slows down display updating. | |
7 | 2930 8 Allow the user to add items to the Syntax menu sorted, without having to |
2931 change this for each release. | |
2932 8 Add a "matchcontains" for regions: items contained in the start or end | |
2933 pattern, but not in the body. | |
2934 8 Add a "keepend-contained" argument: Don't change the end of an item this | |
2935 one is contained in. Like "keepend" but specified on the contained item, | |
2936 instead of the containing item. | |
2937 8 cpp.vim: In C++ it's allowed to use {} inside (). | |
2938 8 Some syntax files set 'iskeyword'. When switching to another filetype | |
2939 this isn't reset. Add a special keyword definition for the syntax rules? | |
2940 When this is done, use vim.vim syntax highlighting for help file examples, | |
2941 but without ":" in 'iskeyword' for syntax. | |
2942 8 Add specific syntax item to match with parens/braces that don't have a | |
2943 "%" match. :syntax nomatch cMatchError (,{,[,),},] [contained] | |
2944 8 Highlight the text between two matching parens (e.g., with a grey | |
2945 background) when on one of the parens or in between them. | |
694 | 2946 Option for the matchparen plugin? |
7 | 2947 8 When using a cterm, and no ctermfg or ctermbg are defined, use start/stop |
2948 sequences. Add remark in docs that :if 'term' == "term-name" should be | |
2949 used. | |
2950 8 Add @spell cluster to String and Comment groups for many languages. Will | |
2951 allow spell checking. (Fleiner) | |
2952 8 When listing syntax items, try to sort the keywords alphabetically. And | |
2953 re-insert the [] if possible. | |
2954 8 Make it possible to use color of text for Visual highlight group (like for | |
2955 the Cursor). | |
557 | 2956 8 It would be useful to make the highlight group name an expression. Then |
2957 when there is a match, the expression would be evaluated to find out what | |
2958 highlight group to use. Could be used to check if the shell used in a | |
2959 password file appears in /etc/shells. (Nikolai Weibull) | |
2960 syn match =s:checkShell(v:match) contained 'pattern' | |
7 | 2961 8 Make it possible to only highlight a sub-expression of a match. Like |
2962 using "\1" in a ":s" command. | |
2963 8 Support for deleting syntax items: | |
2964 :syn keyword cTodo remove this | |
2965 :syn match cTodo remove "pattern" | |
2966 :syn region cString remove start="this" end="that" | |
2967 8 Add possibility to sync on something else, when the syncing in one way | |
2968 doesn't find match. For HTML: When no {script} is found, try looking for | |
2969 a '<'. (Fleiner) | |
2970 7 Replace the synchronizing method with a state machine specification? | |
2971 Should be able to start at any line in the file, search forwards or | |
2972 backwards, and use the result of matching a pattern. | |
2973 7 Use parsing like awk, so that e.g., a ( without a matching ) can be | |
2974 detected. | |
2975 8 Make it possible to use "inverted" highlighting, invert the original | |
237 | 2976 character. For Visual mode. (xterm-selection already does this). |
7 | 2977 8 Highlight non-printable characters with "SpecialChar", linked to |
2978 "Special". Display them with the digraph characters, if possible. | |
2979 8 Highlight the clipboard-selection with a highlight group. | |
2980 8 Be able to reset highlighting to its original (default) values. | |
2981 7 Be able to write current highlighting to a file as commands, similar to | |
2982 ":mkvimrc". | |
2983 8 Improve c.vim: | |
2984 - Add check for unterminated strings, with a variable to switch it on: | |
2985 "c_strict_ansi". | |
2986 - Detect unbalanced "#endif". Requires looking back a long way... | |
2987 8 Add an option to restrict the updating of syntax highlighting to the | |
2988 current line while in Insert mode. | |
2989 8 When guessing value of 'background', the syntax file has already been | |
2990 loaded (from the .gvimrc). After changing 'background', load it again? | |
2991 8 Add ":syn resync" command, to re-parse the whole file until the current | |
2992 display position. | |
2993 8 Should support "me" offset for a region start pattern. To be used to | |
2994 allow searching for the end pattern inside the match of the end pattern. | |
2995 Example: syn region pikeXX start="([^{]" end=")" should work on "()". | |
2996 8 When using a regexp for "contains=", should delay matching with it until | |
2997 redrawing happens. Set a flag when a group is added, check this flag when | |
2998 highlighting starts. | |
1125 | 2999 8 Some terminals can display colors like the GUI. Add some setting to use |
3000 GUI colors for the terminal? With something to define the escape | |
3001 sequence. | |
844 | 3002 7 It's possible for an item to be transparent, so that the colors of an item |
3003 lower on the stack is used. Also do this with highlighting, so that the | |
3004 user can set transparent highlighting? E.g. a number in a C comment would | |
3005 get the color of a comment, a number in an assignment Normal. (Nikolai | |
3006 Weibull) | |
7 | 3007 7 Add "semitrans": Add highlighting. E.g., make the text bold, but keep the |
3008 colors. And add colors, so that Green+Red becomes Yellow. | |
3009 E.g. for this html: | |
3010 <B> bold text <I> italic+bold text </B> italic text </I> | |
3011 7 CTRL-] checks the highlight group for finding out what the tag is. | |
3012 7 Add an explanation how a list of words can be used to highlight misspelled | |
3013 words. | |
3014 8 Add more command line completion for :syntax. | |
3015 8 Add more command line completion for :highlight. | |
3016 7 Should find a better way to parse the :syntax and :highlight commands. | |
3017 Use tables or lists that can be shared by parsing for execution and | |
3018 completion? | |
3019 8 Add ColorSchemePost autocommand event, so that scripts can set up their | |
3020 highlighting. (Salman Halim) | |
3021 7 Add a few sets of colors (e.g. Borland Turbo C one). With a menu to | |
3022 select one of the sets. | |
3023 8 Add offsets to sub-matches: "\(a*\) *"he=e1-1 | |
3024 'e' is end of match 'e1' is end of sub-match 1, 's2' is start of submatch | |
3025 2, etc. | |
3026 8 In Insert mode, when there are typeahead characters, postpone the | |
3027 highlighting (for "." command). | |
3028 8 Syncing on comments isn't 100% correct when / / lines mix with / * and * /. | |
3029 For example: What about a line that starts with / / and contains * /? | |
3030 8 Ignore / * and * / inside strings, when syncing. | |
3031 7 Build a few more syntax files from the file "/usr/share/misc/vgrindefs": | |
3032 ISP, LDL, Icon, ratfor. And check "nedit/source/highlight.c". | |
3033 6 Add possibility to have background color continue until the right edge of | |
3034 the window. Useful for comment blocks and function headings. (Rogall) | |
3035 - Make it possible to add "contains" items for all items in a group. Useful | |
3036 when extending an already existing syntax file. | |
3037 - Add line-continuation pattern for non-syncing items too? | |
3038 - Add possibility to highlight the whole line, including the right margin | |
3039 (for comment blocks). | |
3040 - Add 'hlmatch' option: List of flags: | |
3041 'c': highlight match for character under the cursor. | |
3042 'b': highlight the previous (, and its match. | |
3043 'a': highlight all text from the previous ( until its match. | |
3044 Also for {}, <>, etc.? | |
3045 'e': highlight all braces without a match (slow?) | |
3046 OR: add an argument "cursor" to the syntax command, which means that the | |
3047 region/match/keyword is only highlighted when the cursor is on it. | |
3048 (Campbell) | |
3049 Or do it like Elvis: define text objects and how to highlight them around | |
3050 the cursor. (Iain Truskett) | |
3051 7 Make it possible to use all words in the tags files as Keyword. | |
3052 Can also be done with a script (but it's slow). | |
3053 7 Make it possible to call a ":" command when a match is found. Should | |
3054 allow for adding keywords from the text (e.g. variables that are set). | |
3055 And allows for sections with different highlighting. | |
3056 7 Add highlight group for commandline: "Commandline". Make sure it | |
3057 highlights the command line while typing a command, and any output from | |
3058 messages. And external commands? | |
3059 8 Make a version that works like less, but with highlighting: read stdin for | |
3060 text, exit at end of file, don't allow editing, etc. moreim? lessim? | |
3061 7 SpecialKey highlighting overrules syntax highlighting. Can't give an | |
3062 unprintable char another color. Would be useful for ^M at end of line. | |
3063 | |
3064 | |
3065 Built-in script language: | |
1624 | 3066 8 Make the filename and line number available to script functions, so that |
3067 they can give useful debugging info. The whole call stack would be ideal. | |
713 | 3068 7 Execute a function with standard option values. No need to save and |
3069 restore option values. Especially useful for new options. Problem: how | |
3070 to avoid a performance penalty (esp. for string options)? | |
7 | 3071 8 Add referring to key options with "&t_xx". Both for "echo &t_xx" and |
3072 ":let &t_xx =". Useful for making portable mappings. | |
1125 | 3073 - Add ":let var ?= value", conditional assignment. Patch by Dave Eggum, |
3074 2006 Dec 11. | |
3075 - range for ":exec", pass it on to the executed command. (Webb) | |
2325
f177a6431514
Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3076 8 ":{range}source": source the lines from the current file. |
f177a6431514
Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3077 You can already yank lines and use :@" to execute them. |
f177a6431514
Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3078 Most of do_source() would not be used, need a new function. |
f177a6431514
Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3079 It's easy when not doing breakpoints or profiling. |
f177a6431514
Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3080 Requires copying the lines into a list and then creating a function to |
f177a6431514
Better implementation of creating the Color Scheme menu. (Juergen Kraemer)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3081 execute lines from the list. Similar to getnextac(). |
720 | 3082 7 ":include" command: just like ":source" but doesn't start a new scriptID? |
3083 Will be tricky for the list of script names. | |
7 | 3084 8 Have a look at VSEL. Would it be useful to include? (Bigham) |
3085 8 Add ":fungroup" command, to group function definitions together. When | |
3086 encountered, all functions in the group are removed. Suggest using an | |
3087 obscure name to avoid name clashes. Require a ":fungroup END" in the same | |
3088 sourced file? Assume the group ends at the end of the file. Handle | |
3089 nested packages? | |
3090 Alternative: Support packages. {package-name}:{function-name}(). | |
3091 Packages are loaded automatically when first used, from | |
3092 $VIMRUNTIME/packages (or use a search path). | |
3093 7 Pre-parse or compile Vim scripts into a bytecode. | |
3094 1. Put the bytecode with the original script, with an ":if | |
3095 has('bytecode')" around it, so that it's only used with a Vim that | |
3096 supports it. Update the code with a command, can be used in an | |
3097 autocommand. | |
3098 2. Use a ".vic" file (like Python use .pyc). Create it when writing a | |
3099 .vim file. Problem: distribution. | |
3100 3. Use a cache directory for each user. How to recognize which cached | |
3101 file belongs to a sourced script? | |
3102 7 Add argument to winwidth() to subtract the space taken by 'foldcolumn', | |
3103 signs and/or 'number'. | |
1125 | 3104 6 Add ++ and -- operators? They only work on variables (lvals), how to |
3105 implement this? | |
7 | 3106 8 Add functions: |
1125 | 3107 has(":command") Check if ":command" works. compare function |
3108 with "ex_ni". E.g. for ":simalt". | |
3109 system() With a List argument. Bypasses the shell, use | |
3110 exec() directly. (Bob Hiestand) | |
3111 escape() Add argument to specify what to escape with. | |
3112 modestack() Instead of just the current mode return the | |
3113 stack of Insert / CTRL-O / :normal things. | |
20 | 3114 realname() Get user name (first, last, full) |
3115 user_fullname() patch by Nikolai Weibull, Nov | |
3116 3 2002 | |
3117 Only add this when also implemented for | |
3118 non-Unix systems, otherwise a shell cmd could | |
3119 be used. | |
3120 get_user_name() gets login name. | |
18 | 3121 menuprop({name}, {idx}, {what}) |
3122 Get menu property of menu {name} item {idx}. | |
3123 menuprop("", 1, "name") returns "File". | |
3124 menuprop("File", 1, "n") returns "nmenu | |
3125 File.Open..." argument. | |
3126 Patch by Ilya Sher, 2004 Apr 22 | |
3127 Return a list of menus and/or a dictionary | |
3128 with properties instead. | |
3129 mapname({idx}, mode) return the name of the idx'th mapping. | |
3130 Patch by Ilya Sher, 2004 Mar 4. | |
3131 Return a list instead. | |
170 | 3132 char2hex() convert char string to hex string. |
2826 | 3133 crypt() encrypt string |
3134 decrypt() decrypt string | |
3135 base64enc() base 64 encoding | |
3136 base64dec() base 64 decoding | |
7 | 3137 attributes() return file protection flags "drwxrwxrwx" |
170 | 3138 filecopy(from, to) Copy a file |
3139 shorten(fname) shorten a file name, like home_replace() | |
7 | 3140 perl(cmd) call Perl and return string |
3141 inputrl() like input() but right-to-left | |
1624 | 3142 typed() return the characters typed and consumed (to |
3143 find out what happened) | |
7 | 3144 virtualmode() add argument to obtain whether "$" was used in |
3145 Visual block mode. | |
3146 getacp() Win32: get codepage (Glenn Maynard) | |
3147 deletebufline() delete line in any buffer | |
3148 appendbufline() append line in any buffer | |
3149 libcall() Allow more than one argument. | |
3150 libcallext() Like libcall(), but using a callback function | |
3151 to allow the library to execute a command or | |
3152 evaluate an expression. | |
3153 7 Make bufname("'0") return the buffer name from mark '0. How to get the | |
3154 column and line number? col("'0") currently returns zero. | |
3155 8 argc() returns 0 when using "vim -t tag". How to detect that no file was | |
3156 specified in any way? To be able to jump to the last edited file. | |
1125 | 3157 8 Pass the command line arguments to Vim scripts in some way. As v:args |
3158 List? Or extra parameter to argv()? | |
7 | 3159 8 Add command arguments with three dashes, passed on to Vim scripts. |
3160 7 Add optional arguments to user functions: | |
3161 :func myFunc(arg1, arg2, arg3 = "blah", arg4 = 17) | |
3162 6 User functions: Functions local to buffer "b:func()"? | |
694 | 3163 8 For Strings add ":let var[{expr}] = {expr}". When past the end of "var" |
3164 just ignore. | |
7 | 3165 8 The "= register should be writable, if followed by the name of a variable, |
3166 option or environment variable. | |
3167 8 ":let &option" should list the value of the option. | |
1125 | 3168 8 ":let Func().foo = value" should work, also when "foo" doesn't exist. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3169 Also: ":let Func()[foo] = value" should work. Same for a List. |
694 | 3170 7 Add synIDlist(), making the whole list of syntax items on the syntax stack |
3171 available as a List. | |
7 | 3172 8 Add autocommand-event for when a variable is changed: |
3173 :au VarChanged {varname} {commands} | |
3174 8 Add "has("gui_capable")", to check if the GUI can be started. | |
3175 8 Add possibility to use variables like registers: characterwise (default), | |
3176 linewise (when ending in '\n'), blockwise (when ending in '\001'). reg0, | |
3177 rega, reg%, etc. Add functions linewise({expr}), blockwise({expr}) and | |
3178 charwise({expr}). | |
3179 7 Make it possible to do any command on a string variable (make a buffer | |
3180 with one line, containing the string). Maybe add an (invisible) scratch | |
3181 buffer for this? | |
3182 result = scratch(string, command) | |
3183 result = apply(string, command) | |
3184 result = execute(string, command) | |
3185 "command" would use <> notation. | |
3186 Does scratch buffer have a number? Or re-use same number? | |
3187 7 Add function to generate unique number (date in milliseconds). | |
3188 | |
3189 | |
3190 Robustness: | |
11 | 3191 6 Add file locking. Lock a file when starting to edit it with flock() or |
3192 fcntl(). This patch has advisory file locking while reading/writing | |
3193 the file for Vim 5.4: ~/vim/patches/kahn_file_locking . | |
3194 The patch is incomplete (needs support for more systems, autoconf). | |
3195 Andy doesn't have time to work on it. | |
3196 Disadvantage: Need to find ways to gracefully handle failure to obtain a | |
3197 lock. When to release a lock: When buffer is unloaded? | |
7 | 3198 |
3199 | |
3200 Performance: | |
1668 | 3201 7 For string variables up to 3 bytes don't allocate memory, use v_list |
3202 itself as a character array. Use VAR_SSTRING (short string). | |
2400
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2398
diff
changeset
|
3203 7 Add 'lazysize' option: Above this size Vim doesn't load everything before |
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2398
diff
changeset
|
3204 starting to edit a file. Things like 'fileencodings' only work up to this |
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2398
diff
changeset
|
3205 size, modelines only work at the top. Useful for large log files where |
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2398
diff
changeset
|
3206 you only want to look at the first few pages. Use zero to disable it. |
1668 | 3207 8 move_lines() copies every line into allocated memory, making reloading a |
3208 buffer a lot slower than re-editing the file. Can the memline be locked | |
3209 so that we don't need to make a copy? Or avoid invoking ml_updatechunk(), | |
3210 that is taking a lot of time. (Ralf Wildenhues, 2008 Jul 7) | |
2289
3331756e4232
Make synstack() work on the character just after the end of the line.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2287
diff
changeset
|
3211 With a patch, but does it work? |
1125 | 3212 8 Instead of loading rgb.txt every time a color wasn't recognized load it |
3213 once and keep it in memory. Move the code to a common place to avoid | |
3214 repeating it in various system files. | |
7 | 3215 8 Turn b_syn_ic and b_syn_containedin into b_syn_flags. |
3216 9 Loading menu.vim still takes quite a bit of time. How to make it faster? | |
3217 8 in_id_list() takes much time for syntax highlighting. Cache the result? | |
3218 7 setpcmark() shifts the jumplist, this takes quite a bit of time when | |
3219 jumping around. Instead use an index for the start? | |
3220 8 When displaying a space with only foreground highlighting, it's the same | |
3221 as a space without attributes. Avoid displaying spaces for the "~" lines | |
3222 when starting up in a color terminal. | |
3223 8 Avoid alloc() for scratch buffer use, esp. in syntax.c. It's very slow on | |
3224 Win16. | |
3225 8 Profiling shows that in_id_list() is used very often for C code. Can this | |
3226 function be improved? | |
3227 8 For an existing file, the page size of the swap file is always the | |
3228 default, instead of using the block size of the device, because the swap | |
3229 file is created only after setting the block size in mf_open(). How can | |
3230 this be improved? | |
3231 8 Set default for 'ttyscroll' to half a screen height? Should speed up | |
3232 MS-DOS version. (Negri) | |
36 | 3233 7 C syntax highlighting gets a lot slower after ":set foldmethod=syntax". |
3234 (Charles Campbell) Inserting a "{" is very slow. (dman) | |
7 | 3235 7 HTML syntax highlighting is slow for long lines. Try displaying |
3236 http://www.theregister.co.uk/content/4/22908.html. (Andre Pang) | |
3237 7 Check how performance of loading the wordlist can be improved (adding a | |
3238 lot of abbreviations). | |
2587 | 3239 7 MS-DOS console: Add t_DL support, to make scrolling faster. |
7 | 3240 7 Compile Ex commands to byte codes. Store byte codes in a vim script file |
3241 at the end, after "compiled:. Make it look like a single comment line | |
3242 for old Vim versions. Insert first line "Vim script compiled <timestamp>. | |
3243 Only used compiled code when timestamp matches the file stat. | |
3244 Add command to compile a vim script and add it to the file in-place. | |
3245 Split Ex command executing into a parsing and executing phase. | |
3246 Use compiled code for functions, while loops, etc. | |
3247 8 When defining autocommands (e.g., from $VIMRUNTIME/filetype.vim), need to | |
3248 compare each pattern with all existing patterns. Use a hash code to avoid | |
3249 using strcmp() too often? | |
3250 7 Include turbo_loader patches, speeding up reading a file? | |
3251 Speed up reading a file by reading it into a fixed-size buffer, creating | |
3252 the list of indexes in another buffer, and then copying the result into a | |
3253 memfile block with two copies. Then read the next block into another | |
3254 fixed-size buffer, create the second list of indexes and copy text from | |
3255 the two blocks to the memfile block. | |
3256 7 do_cmdline(): Avoid that the command line is copied to allocated memory | |
3257 and freed again later all the time. For while loops, and for when called | |
3258 with an argument that can be messed with. | |
3259 Generic solution: Make a struct that contains a pointer and a flag that | |
3260 indicates if the pointer should be freed when replaced. | |
3261 7 Check that the file size is not more than "sizeof(long)". | |
3262 - Further improve finding mappings in maphash[] in vgetorpeek() | |
3263 8 Syntax highlighting is slow when deleting lines. Try in | |
3264 $VIMRUNTIME/filetype.vim. | |
3265 - "out of memory" after deleting (1,$d) and changing (:%s/^/> /) a lot of | |
3266 lines (27000) a few times. Memory fragmentation? | |
3267 - Have a look at how pdksh does memory allocation (alloc.c). (Dalecki) | |
3268 - Do profiling on: | |
3269 - :g/pat/normal cmd | |
3270 - 1000ii<Esc> | |
3271 - deleting 10Mbyte worth of lines (netscape binary) | |
3272 - "[i" and "[d" (Yegappan Lakshmanan) | |
3273 - ":g/^/m0" on a 450Kbyte file. And the "u". | |
3274 - highlighting "~/vim/test/longline.tex", "~/vim/test/scwoop.tcl" and | |
3275 "~/vim/test/lockup.pl". | |
3276 - loading a syntax file to highlight all words not from a dictionary. | |
587 | 3277 - editing a Vim script with syntax highlighting on (loading vim.vim). |
7 | 3278 7 Screen updating can be further improved by only redrawing lines that were |
3279 changed (and lines after them, when syntax highlighting was used, and it | |
3280 changed). | |
3281 - On each change, remember start and end of the change. | |
3282 - When inserting/deleting lines, remember begin, end, and line count. | |
3283 - Use macros/duarte/capicua for profiling. Nvi 1.71 is the fastest! | |
3284 - When using a file with one long line (1Mbyte), then do "$hhhh", is still | |
3285 very slow. Avoid calling getvcol() for each "h"? | |
3286 - Executing a register, e.g. "10000@@" is slow, because ins_typebuf has to | |
3287 move the previous commands forward each time. Pass count from | |
3288 normal_cmd() down to do_execreg(). | |
3289 - Repeating insert "1000i-<Esc>" displays --INSERT-- all the time, because of | |
3290 the <Esc> at the end. Make this work faster (disable redrawing). | |
3291 - Avoid calls to plines() for cursor line, use w_cline_height. | |
3292 - After ":set nowrap" remove superfluous redraw with wrong hor. offset if | |
3293 cursor is right of the screen. | |
3294 8 Make CTRL-C on Unix generate a signal, avoid using select() to check for a | |
3295 CTRL-C (it's slow). | |
3296 | |
3297 | |
3298 Code size: | |
3299 8 GUI: When NO_CONSOLE is defined, more code can be excluded. | |
3300 - Put getline() and cookie in a struct, so only one argument has to be | |
3301 passed to do_cmdline() and other functions. | |
3302 8 Make a GUI-only version for Unix? | |
3303 8 In buf_write _() isn't needed when setting errmsg, do it once when using | |
3304 it. | |
3305 7 When compiling with a GUI-only version, the code for cterm colors can be | |
3306 left out. | |
3307 8 When compiled with a GUI-only version, the termcap entries for terminals | |
3308 can be removed. | |
3309 8 Can the check for libelf in configure.in be removed? | |
3310 | |
3311 | |
3312 Messages: | |
3313 8 When using ":q" in a changed file, the error says to "add !". Add the | |
3314 command so that beginners understand it: "use :q!". | |
3315 8 For 'verbose' level 12 prints commands from source'ed files. How to skip | |
3316 lines that aren't executed? Perhaps move the echoing to do_cmdline()? | |
3317 8 Use 'report' for ":bdel"? (Krishna) To avoid these messages when using a | |
3318 script. | |
3319 - Delete message after new command has been entered and have waited for key. | |
3320 Perhaps after ten seconds? | |
3321 - Make message history available in "msg" variables: msg1, msg2, .. msg9. | |
1125 | 3322 8 When reading from stdin allow suppressing the "reading from stdin" |
3323 message. | |
7 | 3324 9 Check handling of overwriting of messages and delays: |
3325 Very wrong: errors while redrawing cause endless loop. | |
3326 When switching to another file and screen scrolls because of the long | |
3327 message and return must be typed, don't scroll the screen back before | |
3328 redrawing. | |
3329 8 When address range is wrong you only get "Invalid range". Be a bit more | |
3330 specific: Negative, beyond last line, reverse range? Include the text. | |
3331 8 Make it possible to ignore errors for a moment ('errorignore'?). Another | |
3332 option to switch off giving error messages ('errorquiet'?). Also an option | |
3333 not to give any messages ('quiet')? Or ":quiet on", ":quiet off". | |
3334 Careful: For a severe error (out of memory), and when the user starts | |
3335 typing, error messages must be switched back on. | |
3336 Also a flag to ignore error messages for shell commands (for mappings). | |
237 | 3337 - Option to set time for emsg() sleep. Interrupt sleep when key is typed? |
587 | 3338 Sleep before second message? |
7 | 3339 8 In Ex silent mode or when reading commands from a file, what exactly is |
3340 not printed and what is? Check ":print", ":set all", ":args", ":vers", | |
3341 etc. At least there should be no prompt. (Smulders) And don't clear the | |
3342 screen when reading commands from stdin. (Kendall) | |
3343 --> Make a difference between informative messages, prompts, etc. and | |
3344 error messages, printing text, etc. | |
3345 8 Window should be redrawn when resizing at the hit-enter prompt. | |
3346 Also at the ":tselect" prompt. Find a generic solution for redrawing when | |
3347 a prompt is present (with a callback function?). | |
3348 | |
3349 | |
3350 Screen updating: | |
3351 7 Add a string to the 'display' option to make CTRL-E and CTRL-Y scroll one | |
3352 screen line, also if this means the first line doesn't start with the | |
3353 first character (like what happens with a single line that doesn't fit). | |
3354 - screen_line(): | |
3355 - insert/delete character stuff. | |
3356 - improve delete rest of line (spaces at end of line). | |
3357 - When moving or resizing window, try to avoid a complete redraw (esp. when | |
3358 dragging the status line with the mouse). | |
3359 - When 'lazyredraw' set, don't echo :ex commands? Need a flag to redraw when | |
3360 waiting for a character. | |
3361 8 Add a ":refresh [winnr]" command, to force updating a window. Useful from | |
3362 an event handler where ":normal" can't be used. Also useful when | |
3363 'lazyredraw' is set in a mapping. | |
3364 7 Make 'list' and 'linebreak' work together. | |
3365 | |
3366 | |
3367 Scrolling: | |
2587 | 3368 8 Add "zy" command: scroll horizontally to put the cursor in the middle. |
7 | 3369 6 Add option to set the overlap for CTRL-F and CTRL-B. (Garhi) |
3370 - extend 'scrollbind' option: 'scrollopt' words "search", "relative", etc.. | |
3371 Also 'e'xecute some commands (search, vertical movements) in all bound | |
3372 windows. | |
3373 7 Add 'scrollbind' feature to make the offset of one window with the next | |
3374 one equal to the window height. When editing one file in both windows it | |
3375 looks like each window displays a page of the buffer. | |
3376 - Allow scrolling by dragging with the mouse (grab a character and move it | |
3377 up/down). Like the "hand" in Acrobat reader. Use Alt-LeftMouse for this? | |
3378 (Goldfarb) | |
3379 - Add command to execute some commands (search, vertical movements) in all | |
3380 bound windows. | |
3381 - Add 'search' option to 'scrollopt' to allow 'scrollbind' windows to | |
3382 be bound by regexp searches | |
9 | 3383 - Add "z>" and "z<": scroll sideways one screenful. (Campbell) |
7 | 3384 - Add option to set the number of lines when not to scroll, instead of the |
3385 fixed number used now (for terminals that scroll slow with a large number | |
3386 of lines but not with a single line). | |
3387 | |
3388 | |
3389 Autoconf: | |
3390 8 Should use acconfig.h to define prototypes that are used by autoheader. | |
3391 8 Some compilers don't give an error for "-OPT:Olimit" but a warning. (Webb) | |
3392 Add a check for the warning, so that "Olimit" can be added automatically? | |
3393 - Autoconf: Use @datadir@ for the system independent files. Make sure the | |
3394 system dependent and system independent files are separated. (Leitner). | |
3395 - Add autoconf check for waitpid()/wait4(). | |
3396 - Remove fcntl() from autoconf, all systems have it? | |
3397 - Set default for 'dictionary', add search for dictionary to autoconf. | |
3398 | |
3399 | |
3400 Perl interface: | |
3401 8 Rename typemap file to something else? | |
3402 7 Make buffers accessed as Perl arrays. (Clark) | |
3403 7 Make it possible to compile with non-ANSI C? | |
3404 6 Tcl/Tk has the "load" command: load a shared library (.so or .dll). | |
3405 | |
3406 | |
3407 Shared libraries: | |
3408 6 Add support for loading shared libraries, and calling functions in it. | |
3409 :libload internal-name libname | |
3410 :libunload internal-name | |
3411 :liblist | |
3412 :libcall internal-name function(arg1, arg2, ...) | |
3413 :libcall function(arg1, arg2, ...) | |
3414 libcall() can have only one integer or String argument at the moment. | |
3415 6 Have a look on how Perl handles loading dynamic libraries. | |
3416 | |
3417 | |
3418 Tags: | |
824 | 3419 9 With ":set tags=./tags,../tags" and a tag appears in both tags files it is |
3420 added twice. Requires figuring out the actual file name for each found | |
3421 match. Remove tag_fname from the match and combine it with the fname in | |
3422 the match (without expanding or other things that take time). When | |
3423 'tagrelative' is off tag_fname isn't needed at all. | |
1668 | 3424 8 For 'tags' wildcard in the file name is not supported, only in the path. |
3425 This is due to it using |file-searching|. Suboptimal solution would be to | |
3426 make the filename or the whole option use |wildcards| globing, better | |
2324
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2320
diff
changeset
|
3427 would be to merge the 2 kinds of globing. originally (Erik Falor, 2008 |
1668 | 3428 April 18), updated (Ian Kelling, 2008 July 4) |
857 | 3429 8 Use a mechanism similar to omni completion to figure out the kind of tab |
3430 for CTRL-] and jump to the appropriate matching tag (if there are | |
3431 several). | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3432 Alternative: be able to define a function that takes the tag name and uses |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3433 taglist() to find the right location. With indication of using CTRL-] so |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3434 that the context can be taken into account. (Robert Webb) |
667 | 3435 7 Can CTRL-] (jump to tag) include a following "." and "->" to restrict the |
3436 number of possible matches? Check tags file for an item that has members. | |
3437 (Flemming Madsen) | |
7 | 3438 8 Scope arguments for ":tag", e.g.: ":tag class:cPage open", like Elvis. |
3439 8 When output of ":tselect" is long, getting the more-prompt, should be able | |
3440 to type the tag number directly. | |
3441 7 Add the possibility to use the "-t {tag}" argument multiple times. Open a | |
3442 window for each tag. | |
3443 7 Make output of ":tselect" a bit nicer. Use highlighting? | |
3444 7 Highlight the "tag 1 of >2" message. New highlight group, or same as "hit | |
3445 bottom" search message. | |
3446 7 When using ":tag" at the top of the tag stack, should add another entry, | |
3447 so CTRL-T can bring you back to where you are now AND to where you were | |
3448 before the previous ":tag" command. (Webb) | |
150 | 3449 - When doing "[^I" or "[^D" add position to tag stack. |
3450 - Add command to put current position to tag stack: ":tpush". | |
1125 | 3451 - Add functions to save and restore the tag stack? Or a command to switch |
3452 to another tag stack? So that you can do something else and come back to | |
3453 what you were working on. | |
7 | 3454 7 When using CTRL-] on someClass::someMethod, separate class from method and |
3455 use ":ta class:someClass someMethod". | |
3456 Include C++ tags changes (Bertin). Change "class::func" tag into "func" | |
3457 with "class=class"? Docs in oldmail/bertin/in.xxx. | |
3458 7 Add ":tagargs", to set values for fields: | |
3459 :tagargs class:someclass file:version.c | |
3460 :tagargs clear | |
3461 These are then the default values (changes the order of priority in tag | |
3462 matching). | |
3463 7 Support for "gtags" and "global"? With ":rtag" command? | |
3464 There is an example for how to do this in Nvi. | |
3465 Or do it like Elvis: 'tagprg' and 'tagprgonce' options. (Yamaguchi) | |
3466 The Elvis method is far more flexible, do it that way. | |
3467 7 Support "col:99" extra field, to position the cursor in that column. With | |
3468 a flag in 'cpoptions' to switch it off again. | |
3469 7 Better support for jumping to where a function or variable is used. Use | |
3470 the id-utils, with a connection to "gid" (Emacs can do it too). Add | |
3471 ":idselect", which uses an "ID" database (made by "mkid") like "tselect". | |
3472 | |
3473 | |
3474 Win32 GUI: | |
3475 8 Make debug mode work while starting up (vim -D). Open console window for | |
3476 the message and input? | |
3477 7 The Python interface only works with one version of Python, selected at | |
3478 compile time. Can this be made to work with version 2.1 and 2.2 | |
3479 dynamically? | |
3480 7 GvimExt: when there are several existing Vims, move the list to a submenu. | |
3481 (Mike McCollister) | |
3482 8 When using "Edit with Vim" for one file it changes directory, when several | |
3483 files are selected and using "Edit with single Vim" the directory isn't | |
3484 changed. At least change directory when the path is the same for all | |
3485 files. Perhaps just use the path of the first file or use the longest | |
3486 common part of the path. | |
3487 8 Add font argument to set the lfCharSet. (Bobcik) | |
3488 8 Somehow automatically detect the system language and set $LANG, so that | |
3489 gettext and menus work. | |
3490 8 Could keep console open to run multiple commands, to avoid the need to hit | |
3491 return in every console. | |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
3492 Also: Look at how Emacs does run external commands: |
7 | 3493 http://www.cs.washington.edu/homes/voelker/ntemacs.html. |
3494 8 Need a separate PopUp menu for modeless selection. Need two new commands: | |
3495 Copy selection to clipboard, Paste selection (as typed text). | |
3496 8 Support copy/paste for other file formats. At least HTML, perhaps RTF. | |
3497 Add "copy special" and "paste special" commands? | |
3498 7 Use different default colors, to match the current Windows color scheme. | |
3499 Sys_WindowText, Sys_Window, etc. (Lionel Schaffhauser) | |
3500 7 Use <C-Tab> to cycle through open windows (e.g., the find dialog). | |
3501 7 <Esc> should close a dialog. | |
3502 7 Keep the console for external commands open. Don't wait for a key to be | |
3503 hit. Re-open it when the user has closed it anyway. Or use a prepended | |
3504 command: ":nowait {cmd}", or ":quiet", which executes {cmd} without any | |
3505 prompts. | |
3506 7 Should be able to set an option so that when you double click a file that | |
3507 is associated with Vim, you can either get a new instance of Vim, or have | |
3508 the file added into an already running Vim. | |
3509 7 The "-P" argument only works for the current codepage. Use wide | |
3510 functions to find the window title. | |
3511 | |
3512 | |
3513 GUI: | |
2826 | 3514 8 Make inputdialog() work for Photon, Amiga. |
7 | 3515 - <C--> cannot be mapped. Should be possible to recognize this as a |
3516 normal "-" with the Ctrl modifier. | |
3517 7 Implement ":popup" for other systems than Windows. | |
3518 8 Implement ":tearoff" for other systems than Win32 GUI. | |
3519 6 Implement ":untearoff": hide a torn-off menu. | |
3520 8 When using the scrollbar to scroll, don't move the cursor position. When | |
3521 moving the cursor: scroll to the cursor position. | |
3522 9 Make <S-Insert> paste from the clipboard by default. (Kunze) | |
3523 7 Menu local to a buffer, like mappings. Or local to a filetype? | |
3524 8 In Buffers menu, add a choice whether selecting a buffer opens it in the | |
3525 current window, splits the window or uses ":hide". | |
3526 8 Dragging the mouse pointer outside of a Vim Window should make the text | |
3527 scroll. Return a value from gui_send_mouse_event() to the machine | |
3528 specific code to indicate the time in which the event should be repeated. | |
3529 8 Make it possible to ignore a mouse click when it's used to give Vim (gvim) | |
3530 window focus. Also when a mouse click is used to bring a window to front. | |
3531 8 Make the split into system independent code and system specific code more | |
3532 explicit. There are too many #ifdefs in gui.c. | |
3533 If possible, separate the Vim code completely from the GUI code, to allow | |
3534 running them in separate processes. | |
3535 7 X11: Support cursorColor resource and "-cr" argument. | |
3536 8 X11 (and others): CTRL-; is not different from ';'. Set the modifier mask | |
3537 to include CTRL for keys where CTRL produces the same ASCII code. | |
471 | 3538 7 Add some code to handle proportional fonts on more systems? Need to draw |
3539 each character separately (like xterm). Also for when a double-width font | |
3540 is not exactly double-width. (Maeda) | |
7 | 3541 8 Should take font from xterm where gvim was started (if no other default). |
3542 8 Selecting font names in X11 is difficult, make a script or something to | |
70 | 3543 select one. |
7 | 3544 8 Visual highlighting should keep the same font (bold, italic, etc.). |
3545 8 Add flag to 'guioptions' to not put anything in the clipboard at all? | |
3546 8 Should support a way to use keys that we don't recognize yet. Add a | |
3547 command that adds entries to special_keys somehow. How do we make this | |
3548 portable (X11, Win32, ..)? | |
3549 7 Add a flag to 'guioptions' that tells not to remove inactive menu items. | |
3550 For systems where greying-out or removing menu items is very slow. The | |
3551 menu items would remain visibly normally, but not do anything. | |
3552 7 Add ":minimize" and ":maximize", which iconize the window and back. | |
3553 Useful when using gvim to run a script (e.g. 2html.vim). | |
3554 7 X11: Is it possible to free allocated colors, so that other programs can | |
3555 use them again? Otherwise, allow disabling allocating the default colors. | |
3556 Or allocate an own colormap (check UAE). With an option to use it. For | |
3557 the commandline, "-install" is mostly used for X11 programs. | |
3558 7 Add command line argument for "gvim" not to start the GUI. Sort of the | |
3559 inverse of "vim -g". (Vikas) | |
3560 7 Should support multi-column menus. | |
3561 - Should add option for where to put the "Help" menu: like Motif at the far | |
3562 right, or with the other menus (but still at the right). | |
3563 - Add menu item to "Keep Insert mode". | |
3564 8 ":mkgvimrc" command, that includes menus. | |
3565 6 Big change: Move GUI to separate program "vimgui", to make startup of vim a | |
3566 lot faster, but still be able to do "vim -g" or ":gui". | |
3567 7 More explicit mouse button binding instead of 'mousemodel'? | |
3568 7 Add option to set the position of the window on the screen. 'windowpos', | |
3569 which has a value of "123,456": <x>,<y>. | |
3570 Or add a command, like ":winsize"? | |
3571 7 Add toolbar for more GUIs. | |
3572 8 Make it possible to use "amenu icon=BuiltIn##", so that the toolbar item | |
3573 name can be chosen free. | |
3574 7 Make it possible to put the toolbar on top, left, right and/or bottom of | |
3575 the window? Allows for softkey-like use. | |
3576 6 Separate the part of Vim that does the editing from the part that runs the | |
3577 GUI. Communicate through a pseudo-tty. Vim starts up, creates a | |
3578 pty that is connected to the terminal. When the GUI starts, the pty is | |
3579 reconnected to the GUI process. When the GUI stops, it is connected to | |
3580 the terminal again. Also use the pty for external processes, it looks | |
3581 like a vt100 terminal to them. Vim uses extra commands to communicate GUI | |
3582 things. | |
3583 7 Motif: For a confirm() dialog <Enter> should be ignored when no default | |
3584 button selected, <Esc> should close the dialog. | |
3585 7 When using a pseudo-tty Vim should behave like some terminal (vt52 looks | |
237 | 3586 simple enough). Terminal codes to/from shell should be translated. |
7 | 3587 - Would it be useful to be able to quit the GUI and go back to the terminal |
3588 where it was started from? | |
3589 7 Support "-visual <type>" command line argument. | |
3590 | |
3591 | |
3592 Autocommands: | |
2908 | 3593 9 Rework the code from FEAT_OSFILETYPE for autocmd-osfiletypes to use |
3594 'filetype'. Only for when the current buffer is known. | |
713 | 3595 - Put autocommand event names in a hashtable for faster lookup? |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3596 8 When the SwapExists event is triggered, provide information about the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3597 swap file, e.g., whether the process is running, file was modified, etc. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3598 Must be possible to check the situation that it's probably OK to delete |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3599 the swap file. (Marc Merlin) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3600 8 When all the patterns for an event are "*" there is no need to expand |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3601 buffer names to a full path. This can be slow for NFS. |
40 | 3602 7 For autocommand events that trigger multiple times per buffer (e.g., |
3603 CursorHold), go through the list once and cache the result for a specific | |
3604 buffer. Invalidate the cache when adding/deleting autocommands or | |
3605 changing the buffer name. | |
271 | 3606 7 Add TagJump event: do something after jumping to a tag. |
662 | 3607 8 Add "TagJumpFile" autocommand: When jumping to another file for a tag. |
3608 Can be used to open "main.c.gz" when "main.c" isn't found. | |
7 | 3609 8 Use another option than 'updatetime' for the CursorHold event. The two |
3610 things are unrelated for the user (but the implementation is more | |
3611 difficult). | |
662 | 3612 7 Add autocommand event for when a buffer cannot be abandoned. So that the |
3613 user can define the action taking (autowrite, dialog, fail) based on the | |
3614 kind of file. (Yakov Lerner) Or is BufLeave sufficient? | |
7 | 3615 8 Autocommand for when modified files have been found, when getting input |
3616 focus again (e.g., FileChangedFocus). | |
3617 Check when: getting focus, jumping to another buffer, ... | |
1125 | 3618 7 Autocommand for when an option is changed. Match buffer name or option |
3619 name? | |
662 | 3620 8 Autocommands should not change registers. And marks? And the jumplist? |
3621 And anything else? Add a command to save and restore these things. | |
7 | 3622 8 Add autocommands, user functions and user commands to ":mkvimrc". |
3623 6 Add KeymapChanged event, so that the effects of a different keymap can be | |
3624 handled (e.g., other font) (Ron Aaron) | |
662 | 3625 7 When trying to open a directory, trigger an OpenDirectory event. |
7 | 3626 7 Add file type in front of file pattern: <d> for directory, <l> for link, |
2826 | 3627 <x> for executable, etc. With commas to separate alternatives. The |
3628 autocommand is only executed when both the file type AND the file pattern | |
3629 match. (Leonard) | |
7 | 3630 5 Add option that specifies extensions which are to be discarded from the |
3631 file name. E.g. 'ausuffix', with ".gz,.orig". Such that file.c.gz will | |
3632 trigger the "*.c" autocommands. (Belabas) | |
3633 7 Add something to break the autocommands for the current event, and for | |
3634 what follows. Useful for a "BufWritePre" that wants to avoid writing the | |
3635 file. | |
3636 8 When editing "tt.gz", which is in DOS format, 'fileformat' stays at | |
3637 "unix", thus writing the file changes it. Somehow detect that the read | |
3638 command used dos fileformat. Same for 'fileencoding'. | |
3639 - Add events to autocommands: | |
3640 Error - When an error happens | |
3641 NormalEnter - Entering Normal mode | |
3642 ReplaceEnter - Entering Replace mode | |
838 | 3643 CmdEnter - Entering Cmdline mode (with type of cmdline to allow |
3644 different mapping) | |
7 | 3645 VisualEnter - Entering Visual mode |
11 | 3646 *Leave - Leaving a mode (in pair with the above *Enter) |
17 | 3647 VimLeaveCheck - Before Vim decides to exit, so that it can be cancelled |
3648 when exiting isn't a good idea. | |
1125 | 3649 CursorHoldC - CursorHold while command-line editing |
26 | 3650 WinMoved - when windows have been moved around, e.g, ":wincmd J" |
7 | 3651 CmdUndefined - Like FuncUndefined but for user commands. |
3652 SearchPost - After doing a search command (e.g. to do "M") | |
3653 PreDirChanged/PostDirChanged | |
3654 - Before/after ":cd" has been used (for changing the | |
3655 window title) | |
3656 ShutDown - when the system is about to shut down | |
3657 InsertCharPost - user typed a character in Insert mode, after inserting | |
3658 the char. | |
3659 BufModified - When a buffer becomes modified, or unmodified (for | |
3660 putting a [+] in the window title or checking out the | |
3661 file from CVS). | |
3662 BufFirstChange - When making a change, when 'modified' is set. Can be | |
3663 used to do a :preserve for remote files. | |
3664 BufChange - after a change was made. Set some variables to indicate | |
3665 the position and number of inserted/deleted lines, so | |
3666 that marks can be updated. HierAssist has patch to add | |
3667 BufChangePre, BufChangePost and RevertBuf. (Shah) | |
1125 | 3668 ViewChanged - triggered when the text scrolls and when the window size |
3669 changes. | |
3670 WinResized - After a window has been resized | |
3671 WinClose - Just before closing a window | |
620 | 3672 - Write the file now and then ('autosave'): |
7 | 3673 *'autosave'* *'as'* *'noautosave'* *'noas'* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3674 'autosave' 'as' number (default 0) |
7 | 3675 Automatically write the current buffer to file N seconds after the |
3676 last change has been made and when |'modified'| is still set. | |
3677 Default: 0 = do not autosave the buffer. | |
3678 Alternative: have 'autosave' use 'updatetime' and 'updatecount' but make | |
3679 them save the file itself besides the swapfile. | |
3680 | |
3681 | |
725 | 3682 Omni completion: |
1668 | 3683 - Add a flag to 'complete' to be able to do omni completion with CTRL-N (and |
3684 mix it with other kinds of completion). | |
725 | 3685 - Ideas from the Vim 7 BOF at SANE: |
3686 - For interpreted languages, use the interpreter to obtain information. | |
3687 Should work for Java (Eclipse does this), Python, Tcl, etc. | |
3688 Richard Emberson mentioned working on an interface to Java. | |
3689 - Check Readline for its completion interface. | |
3690 - Ideas from others: | |
3691 http://www.wholetomato.com/ | |
3692 http://www.vim.org/scripts/script.php?script_id=747 | |
3693 http://sourceforge.net/projects/insenvim | |
3694 or http://insenvim.sourceforge.net | |
3695 Java, XML, HTML, C++, JSP, SQL, C# | |
3696 MS-Windows only, lots of dependencies (e.g. Perl, Internet | |
3697 explorer), uses .dll shared libraries. | |
3698 For C++ uses $INCLUDE environment var. | |
3699 Uses Perl for C++. | |
3700 Uses ctags to find the info: | |
3701 ctags -f $allTagsFile --fields=+aiKmnsSz --language-force=C++ --C++-kinds=+cefgmnpsut-dlux -u $files | |
3702 www.vim.org script 1213 (Java Development Environment) (Fuchuan Wang) | |
3703 IComplete: http://www.vim.org/scripts/script.php?script_id=1265 | |
3704 and http://stud4.tuwien.ac.at/~e0125672/icomplete/ | |
3705 http://cedet.sourceforge.net/intellisense.shtml (for Emacs) | |
3706 Ivan Villanueva has something for Java. | |
2174
755eb92c5961
Move items around in the todo list.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
3707 Emacs: http://www.xref-tech.com/xrefactory/more_c_completion.html |
725 | 3708 Completion in .NET framework SharpDevelop: http://www.icsharpcode.net |
3709 - Pre-expand abbreviations, show which abbrevs would match? | |
3710 | |
3711 | |
7 | 3712 Insert mode completion/expansion: |
713 | 3713 - GUI implementation of the popup menu. |
860 | 3714 7 When searching in other files the name flash by, too fast to read. Only |
3715 display a name every second or so, like with ":vimgrep". | |
1668 | 3716 7 When expanding file names with an environment variable, add the match with |
3717 the unexpanded var. So $HOME/tm expands to "/home/guy/tmp" and | |
3718 "$HOME/tmp" | |
7 | 3719 8 When there is no word before the cursor but something like "sys." complete |
3720 with "sys.". Works well for C and similar languages. | |
3721 9 ^X^L completion doesn't repeat correctly. It uses the first match with | |
3722 the last added line, instead of continuing where the last match ended. | |
3723 (Webb) | |
3724 8 Add option to set different behavior for Insert mode completion: | |
3725 - ignore/match case | |
3726 - different characters than 'iskeyword' | |
1125 | 3727 8 Add option 'isexpand', containing characters when doing expansion (so that |
3728 "." and "\" can be included, without changing 'iskeyword'). (Goldfarb) | |
3729 Also: 'istagword': characters used for CTRL-]. | |
3730 When 'isexpand' or 'istagword' are empty, use 'iskeyword'. | |
3731 Alternative: Use a pattern so that start and end of a keyword can be | |
3732 defined, only allow dash in the middle, etc. | |
7 | 3733 8 Add a command to undo the completion, go back to the original text. |
471 | 3734 7 Completion of an abbreviation: Can leave letters out, like what Instant |
3735 text does: www.textware.com | |
7 | 3736 8 Use the class information in the tags file to do context-sensitive |
3737 completion. After "foo." complete all member functions/variables of | |
3738 "foo". Need to search backwards for the class definition of foo. | |
3739 Should work for C++ and Java. | |
3740 Even more context would be nice: "import java.^N" -> "io", "lang", etc. | |
3741 7 When expanding $HOME/dir with ^X^F keep the $HOME (with an option?). | |
3742 7 Add CTRL-X command in Insert mode like CTRL-X CTRL-N, that completes WORDS | |
3743 instead of words. | |
3744 8 Add CTRL-X CTRL-R: complete words from register contents. | |
3745 8 Add completion of previously inserted texts (like what CTRL-A does). | |
3746 Requires remembering a number of insertions. | |
3747 8 Add 'f' flag to 'complete': Expand file names. | |
3748 Also apply 'complete' to whole line completion. | |
1624 | 3749 - Add a flag to 'complete' to only scan local header files, not system |
3750 header files. (Andri Moell) | |
7 | 3751 - Make it possible to search include files in several places. Use the |
3752 'path' option? Can this be done with the dictionary completion (use | |
3753 wildcards in the file name)? | |
3754 - Make CTRL-X CTRL-K do a binary search in the dictionary (if it's sorted). | |
3755 - Speed up CTRL-X CTRL-K dictionary searching (don't use a regexp?). | |
3756 - Set a mark at the position where the match was found (file mark, could | |
3757 be in another file). | |
3758 - Add CTRL-A command in CTRL-X mode: show all matches. | |
3759 - Make CTRL-X CTRL-L use the 'complete' option? | |
3760 - Add command in CTRL-X mode to add following words to the completed string | |
3761 (e.g. to complete "Pointer->element" with CTRL-X CTRL-P CTRL-W CTRL-W) | |
3762 - CTRL-X CTRL-F: Use 'path' to find completions. | |
3763 - CTRL-X CTRL-F: Option to use forward slashes on MS-Windows? | |
3764 - CTRL-X CTRL-F: Don't replace "$VIM" with the actual value. (Kelly) | |
3765 - Allow listing all matches in some way (and picking one from the list). | |
3766 | |
3767 | |
3768 Command line editing: | |
3769 7 Add commands (keys) to delete from the cursor to the end of the command | |
3770 line. | |
3771 8 Custom completion of user commands can't use the standard completion | |
3772 functions. Add a hook to invoke a user function that returns the type of | |
3773 completion to be done: "file", "tag", "custom", etc. | |
3774 - Add flags to 'whichwrap' for command line editing (cursor right at end of | |
3775 lines wraps to start of line). | |
3776 - Make editing the command line work like Insert mode in a single-line view | |
3777 on a buffer that contains the command line history. But this has many | |
3778 disadvantages, only implement it when these can be solved. Elvis has run | |
3779 into these, see remarks from Steve (~/Mail/oldmail/kirkendall/in.00012). | |
3780 - Going back in history and editing a line there would change the history. | |
3781 Would still need to keep a copy of the history elsewhere. Like the | |
3782 cmdwin does now already. | |
3783 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command. How to switch to normal | |
3784 mode for more commands? <Esc> should cancel the command line. CTRL-T? | |
3785 - To allow "/" and "= need to recursively call getcmdline(), overwrite the | |
3786 cmdline. But then we are editing a command-line again. How to avoid | |
3787 that the user gets confused by the stack of command lines? | |
3788 - Use edit() for normal cmdline editing? Would have to integrate | |
3789 getcmdline() into edit(). Need to solve conflicts between Insert mode | |
3790 and Command-line mode commands. Make it work like Korn shell and tcsh. | |
3791 Problems: | |
3792 - Insert: completion with 'wildchar' | |
3793 - Insert: use cmdline abbreviations | |
3794 - Insert: CTRL-D deletes indent instead of listing matches | |
3795 - Normal: no CTRL-W commands | |
3796 - Normal: no ":" commands? | |
3797 - Normal: allow Visual mode only within one line. | |
3798 - where to show insert/normal mode message? Change highlighting of | |
3799 character in first column? | |
3800 - Implementation ideas: | |
3801 - Set "curwin" and "curbuf" to the command line window and buffer. | |
3802 - curwin->w_topline is always equal to curwin->w_cursor.lnum. | |
3803 - never set 'number', no folding, etc. No status line. | |
3804 - sync undo after entering a command line? | |
3805 - use NV_NOCL flag for commands that are not allowed in Command-line | |
3806 Mode. | |
3807 | |
3808 | |
3809 Command line completion: | |
1624 | 3810 8 Completing ":r ~br" should find matching user names. |
7 | 3811 8 Change expand_interactively into a flag that is passed as an argument. |
3812 8 With command line completion after '%' and '#', expand current/alternate | |
3813 file name, so it can be edited. Also with modifiers, such as "%:h". | |
3814 8 When completing command names, either sort them on the long name, or list | |
3815 them with the optional part inside []. | |
1624 | 3816 8 Add an option to ignore case when doing interactive completion. So that |
3817 ":e file<Tab>" also lists "Filelist" (sorted after matching case matches). | |
7 | 3818 7 Completion of ":map x ": fill in the current mapping, so that it can be |
3819 edited. (Sven Guckes) | |
3820 - For 'wildmenu': Simplify "../bar" when possible. | |
3821 - When using <Up> in wildmenu mode for a submenu, should go back to the | |
3822 current menu, not the first one. E.g., ":emenu File.Save<Up>". | |
3823 8 When using backtick expansion, the external command may write a greeting | |
3824 message. Add an option or commands to remove lines that match a regexp? | |
3825 7 When listing matches of files, display the common path separately from the | |
3826 file names, if this makes the listing shorter. (Webb) | |
3827 - Add command line completion for ":ilist" and friends, show matching | |
3828 identifiers (Webb). | |
3829 8 Add command line completion for "old value" of a command. ":args <key>" | |
3830 would result in the current list of arguments, which you can then edit. | |
3831 7 Add command line completion with CTRL-X, just like Insert mode completion. | |
3832 Useful for ":s/word/xx/". | |
3833 - Add command to go back to the text as it was before completion started. | |
3834 Also to be used for <Up> in the command line. | |
3835 - Add 'wildlongest' option: Key to use to find longest common match for | |
3836 command line completion (default CTRL-L), like 'wildchar'. (Cregut) | |
3837 Also: when there are several matches, show them line a CTRL-D. | |
3838 | |
3839 | |
3840 Command line history: | |
222 | 3841 9 Remember which command lines were actually typed and were not loaded from |
3842 viminfo. When writing viminfo append only these lines, so that lines from | |
3843 other Vim's are not overwritten. | |
7 | 3844 - Add "KeyWasTyped" flag: It's reset before each command and set when a |
3845 character from the keyboard is consumed. Value is used to decide to put a | |
3846 command line in history or not. Put line in history if it didn't | |
3847 completely resulted from one mapping. | |
3848 - When using ":browse", also put the resulting edit command in the history, | |
3849 so that it can be repeated. (Demirel) | |
3850 | |
3851 | |
3852 Insert mode: | |
10 | 3853 9 When 'autoindent' is set, hitting <CR> twice, while there is text after |
3854 the cursor, doesn't delete the autoindent in the resulting blank line. | |
3855 (Rich Wales) This is Vi compatible, but it looks like a bug. | |
7 | 3856 8 When using CTRL-O in Insert mode, then executing an insert command |
3857 "a" or "i", should we return to Insert mode after <Esc>? (Eggink) | |
3858 Perhaps it can be allowed a single time, to be able to do | |
3859 "<C-O>10axyz<Esc>". Nesting this further is confusing. | |
3860 ":map <F2> 5aabc<Esc>" works only once from Insert mode. | |
1624 | 3861 8 When using CTRL-G CTRL-O do like CTRL-\ CTRL-O, but when returning with |
3862 the cursor in the same position and the text didn't change continue the | |
3863 same change, so that "." repeats the whole insert. | |
7 | 3864 7 Use CTRL-G <count> to repeat what follows. Useful for inserting a |
3865 character multiple times or repeating CTRL-Y. | |
1668 | 3866 - Make 'revins' work in Replace mode. |
2788 | 3867 9 Can't use multi-byte characters for 'matchpairs'. |
7 | 3868 7 Use 'matchpairs' for 'showmatch': When inserting a character check if it |
3869 appears in the rhs of 'matchpairs'. | |
3870 - In Insert mode (and command line editing?): Allow undo of the last typed | |
3871 character. This is useful for CTRL-U, CTRL-W, delete and backspace, and | |
3872 also for characters that wrap to the next line. | |
3873 Also: be able to undo CTRL-R (insert register). | |
3874 Possibly use 'backspace'="whole" for a mode where at least a <CR> that | |
3875 inserts autoindent is undone by a single <BS>. | |
3876 - Use CTRL-G in Insert mode for an extra range of commands, like "g" in | |
3877 Normal mode. | |
3878 - Make 'paste' work without resetting other options, but override their | |
3879 value. Avoids problems when changing files and modelines or autocommands | |
3880 are used. | |
3881 - When typing CTRL-V and a digit higher than 2, only expect two digits. | |
3882 - Insert binary numbers with CTRL-V b. | |
3883 - Make it possible to undo <BS>, <C-W> and <C-U>. Bash uses CTRL-Y. | |
3884 | |
3885 | |
3886 'cindent', 'smartindent': | |
2725 | 3887 9 Wrapping a variable initialization should have extra indent: |
3888 char * veryLongName = | |
3889 "very long string" | |
3890 Also check if "cino=+10" is used correctly. | |
1125 | 3891 8 Lisp indenting: "\\" confuses the indenter. (Dorai Sitaram, 2006 May 17) |
1624 | 3892 8 Why are continuation lines outside of a {} block not indented? E.g.: |
3893 long_type foo = | |
3894 value; | |
7 | 3895 8 Java: Inside an anonymous class, after an "else" or "try" the indent is |
3896 too small. (Vincent Bergbauer) | |
832 | 3897 Problem of using {} inside (), 'cindent' doesn't work then. |
7 | 3898 8 In C++ it's possible to have {} inside (): (Kirshna) |
3899 func( | |
3900 new String[] { | |
3901 "asdf", | |
3902 "asdf" | |
3903 } | |
3904 ); | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3905 8 In C++ a function isn't recognized inside a namespace: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3906 (Chow Loong Jin) |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3907 namespace { |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3908 int |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3909 func(int arg) { |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3910 } |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
3911 } |
1125 | 3912 6 Add 'cino' flag for this function argument layout: (Spencer Collyer) |
3913 func( arg1 | |
3914 , arg2 | |
3915 , arg3 | |
3916 ); | |
829 | 3917 7 Add separate "(0" option into inside/outside a function (Zellner): |
7 | 3918 func( |
3919 int x) // indent like "(4" | |
3920 { | |
3921 if (a | |
3922 && b) // indent like "(0" | |
3923 9 Using "{" in a comment: (Helmut Stiegler) | |
3924 if (a) | |
3925 { | |
3926 if (b) | |
3927 { | |
3928 // { | |
3929 } | |
3930 } <-- this is indented incorrect | |
829 | 3931 Problem is that find_start_brace() checks for the matching brace to be in |
3932 a comment, but not braces in between. Requires adding a comment check to | |
3933 findmatchlimit(). | |
237 | 3934 - Make smartindenting configurable. Add 'sioptions', e.g. '#' setting the |
7 | 3935 indent to 0 should be switched on/off. |
3936 7 Support ANSI style function header, with each argument on its own line. | |
3937 - "[p" and "]p" should use 'cindent' code if it's on (only for the first | |
3938 line). | |
3939 - Add option to 'cindent' to set indent for comments outside of {}? | |
3940 - Make a command to line up a comment after a code line with a previous | |
3941 comment after a code line. Can 'cindent' do this automatically? | |
3942 7 Add 'j' flag to 'formatoptions': Remove comment leader when joining lines. | |
3943 - When 'cindent'ing a '}', showmatch is done before fixing the indent. It | |
3944 looks better when the indent is fixed before the showmatch. (Webb) | |
3945 - Add option to make indenting work in comments too (for commented-out | |
3946 code), unless the line starts with "*". | |
3947 - Don't use 'cindent' when doing formatting with "gq"? | |
3948 - When formatting a comment after some text, insert the '*' for the new line | |
3949 (indent is correct if 'cindent' is set, but '*' doesn't get inserted). | |
3950 8 When 'comments' has both "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/" and "s1:(*,mb:*,ex:*)", the | |
3951 'x' flag always uses the first match. Need to continue looking for more | |
3952 matches of "*" and remember all characters that could end the comment. | |
3953 - For smartindent: When typing 'else' line it up with matching 'if'. | |
3954 - 'smartindent': allow patterns in 'cinwords', for e.g. TeX files, where | |
3955 lines start with "\item". | |
3956 - Support this style of comments (with an option): (Brown) | |
3957 /* here is a comment that | |
3958 is just autoindented, and | |
3959 nothing else */ | |
3960 - Add words to 'cinwords' to reduce the indent, e.g., "end" or "fi". | |
3961 7 Use Tabs for the indent of starting lines, pad with spaces for | |
3962 continuation lines. Allows changing 'tabstop' without messing up the | |
3963 indents. | |
829 | 3964 'keeptabs': when set don't change the tabs and spaces used for indent, |
3965 when the indent remains the same or increases. | |
7 | 3966 |
3967 | |
3968 Java: | |
3969 8 Can have {} constructs inside parens. Include changes from Steve | |
3970 Odendahl? | |
3971 8 Recognize "import java.util.Vector" and use $CLASSPATH to find files for | |
3972 "[i" commands and friends. | |
3973 - For files found with 'include': handle "*" in included name, for Java. | |
3974 (Jason) | |
3975 - How to make a "package java.util" cause all classes in the package to be | |
3976 searched? Also for "import java.util.*". (Mark Brophy) | |
3977 | |
3978 | |
3979 'comments': | |
3980 8 When formatting C comments that are after code, the "*" isn't repeated | |
3981 like it's done when there is no code. And there is no automatic wrapping. | |
3982 Recognize comments that come after code. Should insert the comment leader | |
3983 when it's "#" or "//". | |
121 | 3984 Other way around: when a C command starts with "* 4" the "*" is repeated |
3985 while it should not. Use syntax HL comment recognition? | |
7 | 3986 7 When using "comments=fg:--", Vim inserts three spaces for a new line. |
3987 When hitting a TAB, these spaces could be removed. | |
3988 7 The 'n'esting flag doesn't do the indenting of the last (rightmost) item. | |
3989 6 Make strings in 'comments' option a RE, to be able to match more | |
3990 complicated things. (Phillipps) Use a special flag to indicate that a | |
3991 regexp is used. | |
3992 8 Make the 'comments' option with "/* * */" lines only repeat the "*" line | |
3993 when there is a "/*" before it? Or include this in 'cindent'? | |
3994 | |
3995 | |
3996 Virtual edit: | |
3997 8 Make the horizontal scrollbar work to move the text further left. | |
3998 7 Allow specifying it separately for Tabs and beyond end-of-line? | |
3999 | |
4000 | |
4001 Text objects: | |
1624 | 4002 8 Add text object for fold, so that it can be yanked when it's open. |
7 | 4003 8 Add test script for text object commands "aw", "iW", etc. |
1280 | 4004 8 Add text object for part of a CamelHumpedWord and under_scored_word. |
164 | 4005 (Scott Graham) "ac" and "au"? |
169 | 4006 8 Add a text object for any kind of quoting, also with multi-byte |
4007 characters. Option to specify what quotes are recognized (default: all) | |
170 | 4008 use "aq" and "iq". Use 'quotepairs' to define pairs of quotes, like |
4009 'matchpairs'? | |
169 | 4010 8 Add text object for any kind of parens, also multi-byte ones. |
7 | 4011 7 Add text object for current search pattern: "a/" and "i/". Makes it |
4012 possible to turn text highlighted for 'hlsearch' into a Visual area. | |
1624 | 4013 8 Add a way to make an ":omap" for a user-defined text object. Requires |
4014 changing the starting position in oap->start. | |
7 | 4015 8 Add "gp" and "gP" commands: insert text and make sure there is a single |
4016 space before it, unless at the start of the line, and after it, unless at | |
4017 the end of the line or before a ".". | |
4018 7 Add objects with backwards extension? Use "I" and "A". Thus "2dAs" | |
4019 deletes the current and previous sentence. (Jens Paulus) | |
4020 7 Add "g{" and "g}" to move to the first/last character of a paragraph | |
4021 (instead of the line just before/after a paragraph as with "{" and "}"). | |
4022 6 Ignore comment leaders for objects. Make "das" work in reply-email. | |
4023 5 Make it possible to use syntax group matches as a text object. For | |
4024 example, define a "ccItem" group, then do "da<ccItem>" to delete one. | |
4025 Or, maybe just define "dai", delete-an-item, to delete the syntax item the | |
4026 cursor is on. | |
4027 | |
4028 | |
4029 Select mode: | |
4030 8 In blockwise mode, typed characters are inserted in front of the block, | |
4031 backspace deletes a column before the block. (Steve Hall) | |
4032 7 Alt-leftmouse starts block mode selection in MS Word. | |
4033 See http://www.vim.org/tips/tip.php?tip_id=743 | |
4034 7 Add Cmdline-select mode. Like Select mode, but used on the command line. | |
4035 - Change gui_send_mouse_event() to pass on mouse events when 'mouse' | |
4036 contains 'C' or 'A'. | |
4037 - Catch mouse events in ex_getln.c. Also shift-cursor, etc., like in | |
4038 normal_cmd(). | |
4039 - remember start and end of selection in cmdline_info. | |
4040 - Typing text replaces the selection. | |
4041 | |
4042 | |
4043 Visual mode: | |
4044 - When dragging the Visual selection with the mouse and 'scrolloff' is zero, | |
4045 behave like 'scrolloff' is one, so that the text scrolls when the pointer | |
4046 is in the top line. | |
713 | 4047 - Displaying size of Visual area: use 24-33 column display. |
4048 When selecting multiple lines, up to about a screenful, also count the | |
4049 characters. | |
7 | 4050 8 When using "I" or "A" in Visual block mode, short lines do not get the new |
587 | 4051 text. Make it possible to add the text to short lines too, with padding |
7 | 4052 where needed. |
4053 7 With a Visual block selected, "2x" deletes a block of double the width, | |
4054 "3y" yanks a block of triple width, etc. | |
4055 7 When selecting linewise, using "itext" should insert "text" at the start | |
4056 of each selected line. | |
4057 8 What is "R" supposed to do in Visual mode? | |
4058 8 Make Visual mode local to the buffer. Allow changing to another buffer. | |
4059 When starting a new Visual selection, remove the Visual selection in any | |
4060 other buffer. (Ron Aaron) | |
4061 8 Support dragging the Visual area to drop it somewhere else. (Ron Aaron, | |
4062 Ben Godfrey) | |
4063 7 Support dragging the Visual area to drop it in another program, and | |
4064 receive dropped text from another program. (Ben Godfrey) | |
4065 7 With blockwise Visual mode and "c", "C", "I", "A", etc., allow the use of | |
4066 a <CR>. The entered lines are repeated over the Visual area. | |
4067 7 CTRL-V :s should substitute only in the block, not to whole lines. (David | |
4068 Young is working on this) | |
4069 7 Filtering a block should only apply to the block, not to the whole lines. | |
8 | 4070 When the number of lines is increased, add lines. When decreased, pad with |
7 | 4071 spaces or delete? Use ":`<,`>" on the command line. |
4072 8 After filtering the Visual area, make "gv" select the filtered text? | |
4073 Currently "gv" only selects a single line, not useful. | |
4074 7 Don't move the cursor when scrolling? Needed when the selection should | |
4075 stay the same. Scroll to the cursor at any movement command. With an | |
4076 option! | |
4077 7 In Visual block mode, need to be able to define a corner on a position | |
4078 that doesn't have text? Also: when using the mouse, be able to select | |
4079 part of a TAB. Even more: Add a mode where the cursor can be on a screen | |
4080 position where there is no text. When typing, add spaces to fill the gap. | |
4081 Other solution: Always use curswant, so that you can move the cursor to | |
4082 the right column, and then use up/down movements to select the line, | |
4083 without changing the column. | |
4084 6 ":left" and ":right" should work in Visual block mode. | |
4085 7 CTRL-I and CTRL-O should work in Visual mode, but only jump to marks in the | |
4086 current buffer. | |
4087 7 CTRL-A and CTRL-X should increase/decrease all numbers in the Visual area. | |
4088 6 In non-Block mode, "I" should insert the same text in front of each line, | |
4089 before the first non-blank, "gI" in column 1. | |
4090 6 In non-Block mode, "A" should append the same text after each line. | |
4091 6 When in blockwise visual selection (CTRL-V), allow cursor to be placed | |
237 | 4092 right of the line. Could also allow cursor to be placed anywhere on a TAB |
7 | 4093 or other special character. |
4094 6 Add commands to move selected text, without deselecting. | |
4095 | |
4096 | |
4097 More advanced repeating commands: | |
4098 - Add "." command for visual mode: redo last visual command (e.g. ":fmt"). | |
237 | 4099 7 Repeating "d:{cmd}" with "." doesn't work. (Benji Fisher) Somehow remember |
7 | 4100 the command line so that it can be repeated? |
1624 | 4101 - Add "gn": repeat last movement command. Including count. |
237 | 4102 - Add "." command after operator: repeat last command of same operator. E.g. |
7 | 4103 "c." will repeat last change, also when "x" used since then (Webb). |
4104 "y." will repeat last yank. | |
4105 "c2." will repeat the last but one change? | |
4106 Also: keep history of Normal mode commands, add command to list the history | |
4107 and/or pick an older command. | |
4108 - History stack for . command? Use "g." command. | |
4109 | |
4110 | |
4111 Mappings and Abbreviations: | |
4112 8 When "0" is mapped (it is a movement command) this mapping should not be | |
4113 used after typing another number, e.g. "20l". (Charles Campbell) | |
4114 Is this possible without disabling the mapping of the following command? | |
4115 8 Should mapping <C-A> and <C-S-A> both work? | |
4116 7 ":abbr b byte", append "b " to an existing word still expands to "byte". | |
4117 This is Vi compatible, but can we avoid it anyway? | |
4118 8 To make a mapping work with a prepended "x to select a register, store the | |
4119 last _typed_ register name and access it with "&. | |
4120 8 Add ":amap", like ":amenu". | |
725 | 4121 7 Add a mapping that works always, for remapping the keyboard. |
7 | 4122 8 Add ":cab!", abbreviations that only apply to Command-line mode and not to |
4123 entering search strings. | |
4124 8 Add a flag to ":abbrev" to eat the character that triggers the | |
4125 abbreviation. Thus "abb ab xxx" and typing "ab<Space>" inserts "xxx" and | |
4126 not the <Space>. | |
4127 8 Give a warning when using CTRL-C in the lhs of a mapping. It will never | |
4128 (?) work. | |
4129 8 Add a way to save a current mapping and restore it later. Use a function | |
4130 that returns the mapping command to restore it: mapcmd()? mapcheck() is | |
4131 not fool proof. How to handle ambiguous mappings? | |
4132 7 Add <0x8f> (hex), <033> (octal) and <123> (decimal) to <> notation? | |
4133 7 When someone tries to unmap with a trailing space, and it fails, try | |
4134 unmapping without the trailing space. Helps for ":unmap xx | unmap yy". | |
4135 6 Context-sensitive abbreviations: Specify syntax group(s) in which the | |
4136 abbreviations are to be used. | |
4137 - Add mappings that take arguments. Could work like the ":s" command. For | |
4138 example, for a mouse escape sequence: | |
4139 :mapexp <Esc>{\([0-9]*\),\([0-9]*\); H\1j\2l | |
725 | 4140 - Add optional <Number> argument for mappings: |
4141 :map <Number>q ^W^W<Number>G | |
4142 :map <Number>q<Number>t ^W^W<Number1-1>G<Number2>l | |
4143 :map q<Char> :s/<Char>/\u\0/g | |
4144 Or implicit: | |
4145 :map q <Register>d<Number>$ | |
7 | 4146 - Add command to repeat a whole mapping ("." only repeats the last change in |
4147 a mapping). Also: Repeat a whole insert command, including any mappings | |
4148 that it included. Sort-of automatic recording? | |
4149 - Include an option (or flag to 'cpoptions') that makes errors in mappings | |
4150 not flush the rest of the mapping (like nvi does). | |
4151 - Use context sensitiveness of completion to switch abbreviations and | |
4152 mappings off for :unab and :unmap. | |
4153 6 When using mappings in Insert mode, insert characters for incomplete | |
4154 mappings first, then remove them again when a mapping matches. Avoids | |
4155 that characters that are the start of some mapping are not shown until you | |
4156 hit another character. | |
4157 - Add mappings for replace mode: ":rmap". How do we then enter mappings for | |
4158 non-replace Insert mode? | |
4159 - Add separate mappings for Visual-character/block/line mode? | |
4160 - Add 'mapstop' command, to stop recursive mappings. | |
4161 - List mappings that have a raw escape sequence both with the name of the key | |
4162 for that escape sequence (if there is one) and the sequence itself. | |
4163 - List mappings: Once with special keys listed as <>, once with meta chars as | |
237 | 4164 <M-a>, once with the byte values (octal?). Sort of "spell mapping" command? |
7 | 4165 - When entering mappings: Add the possibility to enter meta keys like they |
4166 are displayed, within <>: <M-a>, <~@> or <|a>. | |
4167 - Allow multiple arguments to :unmap. | |
4168 - Command to show keys that are not used and available for mapping | |
4169 ":freekeys". | |
4170 - Allow any character except white space in abbreviations lhs (Riehm). | |
4171 | |
4172 | |
4173 Incsearch: | |
4174 - Add a limit to the number of lines that are searched for 'incsearch'? | |
4175 - When no match is found and the user types more, the screen is redrawn | |
4176 anyway. Could skip that. Esp. if the line wraps and the text is scrolled | |
4177 up every time. | |
4178 - Temporarily open folds to show where the search ends up. Restore the | |
4179 folds when going to another line. | |
4180 - When incsearch used and hitting return, no need to search again in many | |
4181 cases, saves a lot of time in big files. (Slootman wants to work on this?) | |
4182 When not using special characters, can continue search from the last match | |
4183 (or not at all, when there was no match). See oldmail/webb/in.872. | |
4184 - With incsearch, use CTRL-N/CTRL-P to go to next/previous match, some other | |
4185 key to copy matched word to search pattern (Alexander Schmid). | |
4186 | |
4187 | |
4188 Searching: | |
625 | 4189 8 Add "g/" and "gb" to search for a pattern in the Visually selected text? |
40 | 4190 "g?" is already used for rot13. |
1125 | 4191 The vis.vim script has a ":S" command that does something like this. |
625 | 4192 Can use "g/" in Normal mode, uses the '< to '> area. |
1125 | 4193 Use "&/" for searching the text in the Visual area? |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4194 9 Add "v" offset: "/pat/v": search for pattern and start Visual mode on the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4195 matching text. |
2725 | 4196 8 Add a modifier to interpret a space like "\_s\+" to make it much easier to |
4197 search for a phrase. | |
231 | 4198 8 Add a mechanism for recursiveness: "\@(([^()]*\@g[^()]*)\)". \@g stands |
4199 for "go recursive here" and \@( \) marks the recursive part. | |
4200 Perl does it this way: | |
4201 $paren = qr/ \(( [^()] | (??{ $paren }) )* \) /x; | |
4202 Here $paren is evaluated when it's encountered. This is like a regexp | |
4203 inside a regexp. In the above terms it would be: | |
4204 \@((\([^()]\|\@g\)*)\) | |
1125 | 4205 8 Show the progress every second. Could use the code that checks for CTRL-C |
4206 to find out how much time has passed. Or use SIGALRM. Where to show the | |
4207 number? | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4208 8 When using an expression for ":s", set the match position in a v: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4209 variable. So that you can do ":%s/^/\=v:lnum/" to put a line number |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4210 before each line. |
328 | 4211 7 Support for approximate-regexps to find similar words (agrep |
4212 http://www.tgries.de/agrep/ tre: http://laurikari.net/tre/index.html). | |
218 | 4213 8 Add an item for a big character range, so that one can search for a |
4214 chinese character: \z[234-1234] or \z[XX-YY] or \z[0x23-0x234]. | |
39 | 4215 7 Add an item stack to allow matching (). One side is "push X on |
7 | 4216 the stack if previous atom matched". Other side is "match with top of |
4217 stack, pop it when it matches". Use "\@pX" and "\@m"? | |
4218 Example: \((\@p).\{-}\@m\)* | |
4219 7 Add an option to accept a match at the cursor position. Also for | |
4220 search(). (Brett) | |
39 | 4221 7 Add a flag to "/pat/" to discard an error. Useful to continue a mapping |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4222 when a search fails. Could be "/pat/E" (e is already used for end offset). |
7 | 4223 7 Add pattern item to use properties of Unicode characters. In Perl it's |
4224 "\p{L}" for a letter. See Regular Expression Pocket Reference. | |
4225 8 Would it be possible to allow ":23,45/pat/flags" to search for "pat" in | |
4226 lines 23 to 45? Or does this conflict with Ex range syntax? | |
4227 8 Allow identical pairs in 'matchpairs'. Restrict the search to the current | |
4228 line. | |
4229 7 Allow longer pairs in 'matchpairs'. Use ~/vim/macros/matchit.vim as an | |
4230 example. | |
4231 8 Make it possible to define the character that "%" checks for in | |
4232 #if/#endif. For nmake it's !if/!endif. | |
4233 - For "%" command: set hierarchy for which things include other things that | |
4234 should be ignored (like "*/" or "#endif" inside /* */). | |
4235 Also: use "%" to jump from start to end of syntax region and back. | |
4236 Alternative: use matchit.vim | |
4237 8 "/:/e+1" gets stuck on a match at the end of the line. Do we care? | |
4238 8 A pattern like "\([^a]\+\)\+" takes an awful long time. Recognize that | |
4239 the recursive "\+" is meaningless and optimize for it. | |
4240 This one is also very slow on "/* some comment */": "^\/\*\(.*[^/]\)*$". | |
4241 7 Recognize "[a-z]", "[0-9]", etc. and replace them with the faster "\l" and | |
4242 "\d". | |
24 | 4243 7 Add a way to specify characters in <C-M> or <Key> form. Could be |
4244 \%<C-M>. | |
7 | 4245 8 Add an argument after ":s/pat/str/" for a range of matches. For example, |
4246 ":s/pat/str/#3-4" to replace only the third and fourth "pat" in a line. | |
1624 | 4247 8 When 'iskeyword' is changed the matches from 'hlsearch' may change. (Benji |
4248 Fisher) redraw if some options are set while 'hlsearch' is set? | |
7 | 4249 8 Add an option not to use 'hlsearch' highlighting for ":s" and ":g" |
4250 commands. (Kahn) It would work like ":noh" is used after that command. | |
4251 Also: An extra flag to do this once, and a flag to keep the existing | |
4252 search pattern. | |
1624 | 4253 - Make 'hlsearch' a local/global option, so that it can be disabled in some |
4254 of the windows. | |
7 | 4255 - Add \%h{group-name}; to search for a specific highlight group. |
4256 Add \%s{syntax-group}; to search for a specific syntax group. | |
4257 - Support Perl regexp. Use PCRE (Perl Compatible RE) package. (Shade) | |
4258 Or translate the pattern to a Vim one. | |
4259 Don't switch on with an option for typed commands/mappings/functions, it's | |
4260 too confusing. Use "\@@" in the pattern, to avoid incompatibilities. | |
1624 | 4261 8 Add a way to access the last substitute text, what is used for ":s//~/". |
4262 Can't use the ~ register, it's already used for drag & drop. | |
7 | 4263 - Remember flags for backreferenced items, so that "*" can be used after it. |
4264 Check with "\(\S\)\1\{3}". (Hemmerling) | |
1624 | 4265 8 Flags that apply to the whole pattern. |
4266 This works for all places where a regexp is used. | |
4267 Add "\q" to not store this pattern as the last search pattern? | |
7 | 4268 - Add flags to search command (also for ":s"?): |
4269 i ignore case | |
4270 I use case | |
4271 p use Perl regexp syntax (or POSIX?) | |
4272 v use Vi regexp syntax | |
4273 f forget pattern, don't keep it for "n" command | |
4274 F remember pattern, keep it for "n" command | |
4275 Perl uses these too: | |
4276 e evaluate the right side as an expression (Perl only) | |
4277 m multiple line expression (we don't need it) | |
4278 o compile only once (Perl only) | |
4279 s single line expression (we don't need it) | |
4280 x extended regexp (we don't need it) | |
4281 When used after ":g" command, backslash needed to avoid confusion with the | |
4282 following command. | |
4283 Add 'searchflags' for default flags (replaces 'gdefault'). | |
4284 - Add command to display the last used substitute pattern and last used | |
4285 pattern. (Margo) Maybe make it accessible through a register (like "/ | |
4286 for search string)? | |
4287 7 Use T-search algorithm, to speed up searching for strings without special | |
4288 characters. See C't article, August 1997. | |
4289 - Add 'fuzzycase' option, so that case doesn't matter, and '-' and '_' are | |
4290 equivalent (for Unix filenames). | |
4291 - Add 'v' flag to search command: enter Visual mode, with the matching text | |
4292 as Visual area. (variation on idea from Bertin) | |
4293 - Searching: "/this//that/" should find "that" after "this". | |
4294 - Add global search commands: Instead of wrapping at the end of the buffer, | |
237 | 4295 they continue in another buffer. Use flag after search pattern: |
7 | 4296 a for the next file in the argument list |
4297 f for file in the buffer list | |
4298 w for file edited in a window. | |
237 | 4299 e.g. "/pat/f". Then "n" and "N" work through files too. "f" flag also for |
4300 ":s/pat/foo/f"??? Then when 'autowrite' and 'hidden' are both not set, ask | |
7 | 4301 before saving files: "Save modified buffer "/path/file"? (Yes/Hide/No |
4302 Save-all/hide-All/Quit) ". | |
4303 - ":s/pat/foo/3": find 3rd match of "pat", like sed. (Thomas Koehler) | |
4304 7 When searching with 'n' give message when getting back where the search | |
237 | 4305 first started. Remember start of search in '/ mark. |
7 | 4306 7 Add option that scrolls screen to put cursor in middle of screen after |
4307 search always/when off-screen/never. And after a ":tag" command. Maybe | |
4308 specify how many lines below the screen causes a redraw with the cursor in | |
4309 the middle (default would be half a screen, zero means always). | |
4310 6 Support multiple search buffers, so macros can be made without side | |
4311 effects. | |
4312 7 From xvim: Allow a newline in search patterns (also for :s, can delete | |
4313 newline). Add BOW, EOW, NEWL, NLORANY, NLBUTANY, magic 'n' and 'r', etc. | |
4314 [not in xvim:] Add option to switch on matches crossing ONE line boundary. | |
271 | 4315 7 Add ":iselect", a combination of ":ilist" and ":tselect". (Aaron) (Zellner) |
7 | 4316 Also ":dselect". |
4317 | |
4318 | |
4319 Undo: | |
1624 | 4320 9 After undo/redo, in the message show whether the buffer is modified or |
4321 not. | |
2310
3e4574a4b627
Fix a few compiler warnings.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2309
diff
changeset
|
4322 8 Use timestamps for undo, so that a version a certain time ago can be found |
3e4574a4b627
Fix a few compiler warnings.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2309
diff
changeset
|
4323 and info before some time/date can be flushed. 'undopersist' gives maximum |
3e4574a4b627
Fix a few compiler warnings.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2309
diff
changeset
|
4324 time to keep undo: "3h", "1d", "2w", "1y", etc. |
3e4574a4b627
Fix a few compiler warnings.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2309
diff
changeset
|
4325 8 Search for pattern in undo tree, showing when it happened and the text |
3e4574a4b627
Fix a few compiler warnings.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2309
diff
changeset
|
4326 state, so that you can jump to it. |
1125 | 4327 8 Undo tree: visually show the tree somehow (Damian Conway) |
4328 Show only the leaves, indicating how many changed from the branch and the | |
4329 timestamp? | |
4330 Put branch with most recent change on the left, older changes get more | |
4331 indent? | |
1624 | 4332 8 See ":e" as a change operation, find the changes and add them to the |
4333 undo info. Also be able to undo the "Reload file" choice for when a file | |
4334 was changed outside of Vim. | |
4335 Would require doing a diff between the buffer text and the file and | |
4336 storing the differences. | |
2316
db0ea641e382
Fix: cursor line not properly concealed when moving between windows.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2315
diff
changeset
|
4337 Alternative: before reloading a buffer, store it somewhere. Keep a list |
db0ea641e382
Fix: cursor line not properly concealed when moving between windows.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2315
diff
changeset
|
4338 of about 10 last reloaded buffers. |
26 | 4339 - Make it possible to undo all the commands from a mapping, including a |
4340 trailing unfinished command, e.g. for ":map K iX^[r". | |
7 | 4341 - When accidentally hitting "R" instead of Ctrl-R, further Ctrl-R is not |
4342 possible, even when typing <Esc> immediately. (Grahn) Also for "i", "a", | |
4343 etc. Postpone saving for undo until something is really inserted? | |
4344 8 When Inserting a lot of text, it can only be undone as a whole. Make undo | |
4345 sync points at every line or word. Could recognize the start of a new | |
4346 word (white space and then non-white space) and backspacing. | |
4347 Can already use CTRL-G u, but that requires remapping a lot of things. | |
4348 8 Make undo more memory-efficient: Compare text before and after change, | |
4349 only remember the lines that really changed. | |
4350 7 Add undo for a range of lines. Can change these back to a previous | |
4351 version without changing the rest of the file. Stop doing this when a | |
4352 change includes only some of these lines and changes the line count. Need | |
4353 to store these undo actions as a separate change that can be undone. | |
4354 - For u_save() include the column number. This can be used to set '[ and ']. | |
4355 And in the future the undo can be made more efficient (Webb). | |
4356 - In out-of-memory situations: Free allocated space in undo, and reduce the | |
4357 number of undo levels (with confirmation). | |
4358 - Instead of [+], give the number of changes since the last write: [+123]. | |
4359 When undoing to before the last write, change this to a negative number: | |
4360 [-99]. | |
4361 - With undo with simple line delete/insert: optimize screen updating. | |
4362 - When executing macro's: Save each line for undo only once. | |
4363 - When doing a global substitute, causing almost all lines to be changed, | |
4364 undo info becomes very big. Put undo info in swap file?? | |
4365 | |
4366 | |
4367 Buffer list: | |
4368 7 Command to execute a command in another buffer: ":inbuf {bufname} {cmd}". | |
4369 Also for other windows: ":inwin {winnr} {cmd}". How to make sure that | |
4370 this works properly for all commands, and still be able to return to the | |
4371 current buffer/window? E.g.: ":inbuf xxx only". | |
4372 8 Add File.{recent_files} menu entries: Recently edited files. | |
4373 Ron Aaron has a plugin for this: mru.vim. | |
4374 8 Unix: Check all uses of fnamecmp() and fnamencmp() if they should check | |
4375 inode too. | |
4376 7 Add another number for a buffer, which is visible for the user. When | |
237 | 4377 creating a new buffer, use the lowest number not in use (or the highest |
4378 number in use plus one?). | |
7 | 4379 7 Offer some buffer selection from the command line? Like using ":ls" and |
4380 asking for a buffer number. (Zachmann) | |
4381 - When starting to edit a file that is already in the buffer list, use the | |
4382 file name argument for the new short file name. (Webb) | |
4383 - Add an option to make ":bnext" and ":bprev" wrap around the end of the | |
4384 buffer list. Also for ":next" and ":prev"? | |
4385 7 Add argument to ":ls" which is a pattern for buffers to list. | |
4386 E.g. ":ls *.c". (Thompson) | |
4387 7 Add expansion of buffer names, so that "*.c" is expanded to all buffer | |
4388 names. Needed for ":bdel *.c", ":bunload *.c", etc. | |
4389 8 Support for <afile> where a buffer name is expected. | |
237 | 4390 8 Some commands don't use line numbers, but buffer numbers. '$' |
7 | 4391 should then mean the number of the last buffer. E.g.: "4,$bdel". |
4392 7 Add an option to mostly use slashes in file names. Separately for | |
4393 internal use and for when executing an external program? | |
2662 | 4394 8 Some file systems are case-sensitive, some are not. Besides |
4395 'wildignorecase' there might be more parts inside | |
4396 CASE_INSENSITIVE_FILENAME that are useful on Unix. | |
7 | 4397 |
4398 | |
4399 Swap (.swp) files: | |
4400 8 If writing to the swap file fails, should try to open one in another | |
4401 directory from 'dir'. Useful in case the file system is full and when | |
4402 there are short file name problems. | |
4403 8 Also use the code to try using a short file name for the backup and swap | |
4404 file for the Win32 and Dos 32 bit versions. | |
4405 8 When a file is edited by root, add $LOGNAME to know who did su. | |
4406 8 When the edited file is a symlink, try to put the swap file in the same | |
237 | 4407 dir as the actual file. Adjust FullName(). Avoids editing the same file |
7 | 4408 twice (e.g. when using quickfix). Also try to make the name of the backup |
4409 file the same as the actual file? | |
4410 Use the code for resolve()? | |
4411 7 When using 64 bit inode numbers, also store the top 32 bits. Add another | |
4412 field for this, using part of bo_fname[], to keep it compatible. | |
4413 7 When editing a file on removable media, should put swap file somewhere | |
237 | 4414 else. Use something like 'r' flag in 'viminfo'. 'diravoid'? |
7 | 4415 Also: Be able to specify minimum disk space, skip directory when not |
4416 enough room. | |
4417 7 Add a configure check for which directory should be used: /tmp, /var/tmp | |
4418 or /var/preserve. | |
4419 - Add an option to create a swap file only when making the first change to | |
4420 the buffer. (Liang) Or only when the buffer is not read-only. | |
4421 - Add option to set "umask" for backup files and swap files (Antwerpen). | |
4422 'backupumask' and 'swapumask'? Or 'umaskback' and 'umaskswap'? | |
4423 - When editing a readonly file, don't use a swap file but read parts from the | |
4424 original file. Also do this when the file is huge (>'maxmem'). We do | |
4425 need to load the file once to count the number of lines? Perhaps keep a | |
4426 cached list of which line is where. | |
4427 | |
4428 | |
4429 Viminfo: | |
4430 7 Can probably remove the code that checks for a writable viminfo file, | |
4431 because we now do the chown() for root, and others can't overwrite someone | |
4432 else's viminfo file. | |
1280 | 4433 8 When there is no .viminfo file and someone does "su", runs Vim, a |
4434 root-owned .viminfo file is created. Is there a good way to avoid this? | |
4435 Perhaps check the owner of the directory. Only when root? | |
7 | 4436 8 Add argument to keep the list of buffers when Vim is started with a file |
4437 name. (Schild) | |
4438 8 Keep the last used directory of the file browser (File/Open menu). | |
4439 8 Remember the last used register for "@@". | |
1624 | 4440 8 Remember the redo buffer, so that "." works after restarting. |
7 | 4441 8 Remember a list of last accessed files. To be used in the |
4442 "File.Open Recent" menu. Default is to remember 10 files or so. | |
4443 Also remember which files have been read and written. How to display | |
4444 this? | |
4445 7 Also store the ". register (last inserted text). | |
4446 7 Make it possible to store buffer names in viminfo file relative to some | |
4447 directory, to make them portable over a network. (Aaron) | |
4448 6 Store a snapshot of the currently opened windows. So that when quitting | |
4449 Vim, and then starting again (without a file name argument), you see the | |
4450 same files in the windows. Use ":mksession" code? | |
4451 - Make marks present in .viminfo usable as file marks: Display a list of | |
4452 "last visited files" and select one to jump to. | |
4453 | |
4454 | |
4455 Modelines: | |
4456 8 Before trying to execute a modeline, check that it looks like one (valid | |
4457 option names). If it's very wrong, silently ignore it. | |
4458 Ignore a line that starts with "Subject: ". | |
1624 | 4459 - Add an option to whitelist options that are allowed in a modeline. This |
4460 would allow careful users to use modelines, e.g., only allowing | |
4461 'shiftwidth'. | |
4462 - Add an option to let modelines only set local options, not global ones | |
4463 such as 'encoding'. | |
7 | 4464 - When an option value is coming from a modeline, do not carry it over to |
4465 another edited file? Would need to remember the value from before the | |
4466 modeline setting. | |
4467 - Allow setting a variable from a modeline? Only allow using fixed strings, | |
4468 no function calls, to avoid a security problem. | |
4469 - Allow ":doauto BufRead x.cpp" in modelines, to execute autocommands for | |
4470 .cpp files. | |
4471 - Support the "abbreviate" command in modelines (Kearns). Careful for | |
4472 characters after <Esc>, that is a security leak. | |
4473 - Add option setting to ask user if he wants to have the modelines executed | |
4474 or not. Same for .exrc in local dir. | |
4475 | |
4476 | |
580 | 4477 Sessions: |
4478 8 DOS/Windows: ":mksession" generates a "cd" command where "aa\#bb" means | |
4479 directory "#bb" in "aa", but it's used as "aa#bb". (Ronald Hoellwarth) | |
4480 7 When there is a "help.txt" window in a session file, restoring that | |
4481 session will not get the "LOCAL ADDITIONS" back. | |
7 | 4482 8 With ":mksession" always store the 'sessionoptions' option, even when |
4483 "options" isn't in it. (St-Amant) | |
580 | 4484 8 When using ":mksession", also store a command to reset all options to |
4485 their default value, before setting the options that are not at their | |
4486 default value. | |
4487 7 With ":mksession" also store the tag stack and jump history. (Michal | |
4488 Malecki) | |
4489 7 Persistent variables: "p:var"; stored in viminfo file and sessions files. | |
856 | 4490 |
580 | 4491 |
4492 Options: | |
374 | 4493 7 ":with option=value | command": temporarily set an option value and |
4494 restore it after the command has executed. | |
7 | 4495 8 Make "old" number options that really give a number of effects into string |
4496 options that are a comma separated list. The old number values should | |
4497 also be supported. | |
4498 8 Add commands to save and restore an option, which also preserves the flag | |
4499 that marks if the option was set. Useful to keep the effect of setting | |
4500 'compatible' after ":syntax on" has been used. | |
4501 7 There is 'titleold', why is there no 'iconold'? (Chazelas) | |
4502 7 Make 'scrolloff' a global-local option, so that it can be different in the | |
4503 quickfix window, for example. (Gary Holloway) | |
4504 | |
4505 | |
4506 External commands: | |
4507 8 When filtering text, redirect stderr so that it can't mess up the screen | |
4508 and Vim doesn't need to redraw it. Also for ":r !cmd". | |
4509 4 Set separate shell for ":sh", piping "range!filter", reading text "r !ls" | |
4510 and writing text "w !wc". (Deutsche) Allow arguments for fast start (e.g. | |
4511 -f). | |
4512 4 Allow direct execution, without using a shell. | |
4513 4 Run an external command in the background. But how about I/O in the GUI? | |
4514 Careful: don't turn Vim into a shell! | |
4515 4 Add feature to disable using a shell or external commands. | |
4516 | |
4517 | |
4518 Multiple Windows: | |
4519 7 "vim -oO file ..." use both horizontal and vertical splits. | |
4520 8 Add CTRL-W T: go to the top window in the column of the current window. | |
4521 And CTRL-W B: go to bottom window. | |
4522 7 Use CTRL-W <Tab>, like alt-tab, to switch between buffers. Repeat <Tab> | |
4523 to select another buffer (only loaded ones?), <BS> to go back, <Enter> to | |
4524 select buffer, <Esc> to go back to original buffer. | |
1668 | 4525 7 Make it possible to edit a new buffer in the preview window. A script can |
4526 then fill it with something. ":popen"? | |
782 | 4527 7 Add a 'tool' window: behaves like a preview window but there can be |
4528 several. Don't count it in only_one_window(). (Alexei Alexandrov) | |
7 | 4529 6 Add an option to resize the shell when splitting and/or closing a window. |
4530 ":vsp" would make the shell wider by as many columns as needed for the new | |
237 | 4531 window. Specify a maximum size (or use the screen size). ":close" would |
7 | 4532 shrink the shell by as many columns as come available. (Demirel) |
4533 7 When starting Vim several times, instantiate a Vim server, that allows | |
4534 communication between the different Vims. Feels like one Vim running with | |
4535 multiple top-level windows. Esp. useful when Vim is started from an IDE | |
4536 too. Requires some form of inter process communication. | |
4537 - Support a connection to an external viewer. Could call the viewer | |
4538 automatically after some seconds of non-activity, or with a command. | |
4539 Allow some way of reporting scrolling and cursor positioning in the viewer | |
4540 to Vim, so that the link between the viewed and edited text can be made. | |
4541 | |
4542 | |
4543 Marks: | |
1624 | 4544 8 Add ten marks for last changed files: ':0, ':1, etc. One mark per file. |
7 | 4545 8 When cursor is first moved because of scrolling, set a mark at this |
4546 position. (Rimon Barr) Use '-. | |
237 | 4547 8 Add a command to jump to a mark and make the motion inclusive. g'm and g`m? |
7 | 4548 8 The '" mark is set to the first line, even when doing ":next" a few times. |
4549 Only set the '" mark when the cursor was really moved in a file. | |
4550 8 Make `` and '', which would position the new cursor position in the middle | |
4551 of the window, restore the old topline (or relative position) from when | |
4552 the mark was set. | |
4553 7 Make a list of file marks in a separate window. For listing all buffers, | |
4554 matching tags, errors, etc. Normal commands to move around. Add commands | |
4555 to jump to the mark (in current window or new window). Start it with | |
4556 ":browse marks"? | |
4557 6 Add a menu that lists the Marks like ":marks". (Amerige) | |
4558 7 For ":jumps", ":tags" and ":marks", for not loaded buffers, remember the | |
4559 text at the mark. Highlight the column with the mark. | |
4560 7 Highlight each mark in some way (With "Mark" highlight group). | |
4561 Or display marks in a separate column, like 'number' does. | |
4562 7 Use d"m to delete rectangular area from cursor to mark m (like Vile's \m | |
4563 command). | |
4564 7 Try to keep marks in the same position when: | |
4565 - replacing with a line break, like in ":s/pat/^M/", move marks after the | |
4566 line break column to the next line. (Acevedo) | |
4567 - inserting/deleting characters in a line. | |
4568 5 Include marks for start/end of the current word and section. Useful in | |
4569 mappings. | |
4570 6 Add "unnamed mark" feature: Like marks for the ":g" command, but place and | |
4571 unplace them with commands before doing something with the lines. | |
4572 Highlight the marked lines somehow. | |
4573 | |
4574 | |
4575 Digraphs: | |
3082 | 4576 7 Make "ga" show the keymap for a character, if it exists. |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4577 Also show the code of the character after conversion to 'filenecoding'. |
7 | 4578 - Use digraph table to tell Vim about the collating sequence of special |
4579 characters? | |
26 | 4580 8 Add command to remove one or more (all) digraphs. (Brown) |
7 | 4581 7 Support different sets of digraphs (depending on the character set?). At |
4582 least Latin1/Unicode, Latin-2, MS-DOS (esp. for Win32). | |
4583 | |
4584 | |
4585 Writing files: | |
4586 - In vim_rename(), should lock "from" file when deleting "to" file for | |
4587 systems other than Amiga. Avoids problems with unexpected longname to | |
4588 shortname conversion. | |
4589 8 write mch_isdevice() for Amiga, Mac, VMS, etc. | |
4590 8 When appending to a file, Vim should also make a backup and a 'patchmode' | |
4591 file. | |
4592 8 'backupskip' doesn't write a backup file at all, a bit dangerous for some | |
4593 applications. Add 'backupelsewhere' to write a backup file in another | |
4594 directory? Or add a flag to 'backupdir'? | |
4595 6 Add an option to write a new, numbered, backup file each time. Like | |
4596 'patchmode', e.g., 'backupmode'. | |
4597 6 Make it possible to write 'patchmode' files to a different directory. | |
4598 E.g., ":set patchmode=~/backups/*.orig". (Thomas) | |
4599 6 Add an option to prepend something to the backup file name. E.g., "#". | |
4600 Or maybe allow a function to modify the backup file name? | |
237 | 4601 8 Only make a backup when overwriting a file for the first time. Avoids |
7 | 4602 losing the original when writing twice. (Slootman) |
4603 7 On non-Unix machines, also overwrite the original file in some situations | |
4604 (file system full, it's a link on an NFS partition). | |
4605 7 When editing a file, check that it has been change outside of Vim more | |
4606 often, not only when writing over it. E.g., at the time the swap file is | |
4607 flushed. Or every ten seconds or so (use the time of day, check it before | |
4608 waiting for a character to be typed). | |
4609 8 When a file was changed since editing started, show this in the status | |
4610 line of the window, like "[time]". | |
4611 Make it easier to reload all outdated files that don't have changes. | |
4612 Automatic and/or with a command. | |
4613 | |
4614 | |
4615 Substitute: | |
343 | 4616 8 Substitute with hex/unicode number "\%xff" and "\%uabcd". Just like |
4617 "\%uabcd" in search pattern. | |
237 | 4618 8 Make it easier to replace in all files in the argument list. E.g.: |
7 | 4619 ":argsub/oldword/newword/". Works like ":argdo %s/oldword/newword/g|w". |
4620 - :s///p prints the line after a substitution. | |
4621 - With :s///c replace \&, ~, etc. when showing the replacement pattern. | |
4622 8 With :s///c allow scrolling horizontally when 'nowrap' is effective. | |
4623 Also allow a count before the scrolling keys. | |
237 | 4624 - Add number option to ":s//2": replace second occurrence of string? Or: |
7 | 4625 :s///N substitutes N times. |
4626 - Add answers to ":substitute" with 'c' flag, used in a ":global", e.g.: | |
4627 ":g/pat1/s/pat2/pat3/cg": 'A' do all remaining replacements, 'Q' don't do | |
4628 any replacements, 'u' undo last substitution. | |
4629 7 Substitute in a block of text. Use {line}.{column} notation in an Ex | |
4630 range, e.g.: ":1.3,$.5s" means to substitute from line 1 column 3 to the | |
4631 last line column 5. | |
4632 5 Add commands to bookmark lines, display bookmarks, remove bookmarks, | |
4633 operate on lines with bookmarks, etc. Like ":global" but with the | |
4634 possibility to keep the bookmarks and use them with several commands. | |
4635 (Stanislav Sitar) | |
4636 | |
4637 | |
4638 Mouse support: | |
4639 8 Add 'o' flag to 'mouse'? | |
4640 7 Be able to set a 'mouseshape' for the popup menu. | |
4641 8 Add 'mouse' flag, which sets a behavior like Visual mode, but automatic | |
4642 yanking at the button-up event. Or like Select mode, but typing gets you | |
4643 out of Select mode, instead of replacing the text. (Bhaskar) | |
4644 - Implement mouse support for the Amiga console. | |
4645 - Using right mouse button to extend a blockwise selection should attach to | |
4646 the nearest corner of the rectangle (four possible corners). | |
4647 - Precede mouse click by a number to simulate double clicks?!? | |
4648 - When mouse click after 'r' command, get character that was pointed to. | |
4649 | |
4650 | |
4651 Argument list: | |
4652 6 Add command to put all filenames from the tag files in the argument list. | |
4653 When given an argument, only use the files where that argument matches | |
4654 (like `grep -l ident`) and jump to the first match. | |
4655 6 Add command to form an args list from all the buffers? | |
4656 | |
4657 | |
4658 Registers: | |
4659 8 Don't display empty registers with ":display". (Etienne) | |
4660 8 Make the # register writable, so that it can be restored after jumping | |
4661 around in windows. | |
4662 8 Add put command that overwrites existing text. Should also work for | |
4663 blocks. Useful to move text around in a table. Works like using "R ^R r" | |
4664 for every line. | |
4665 6 When yanking into the unnamed registers several times, somehow make the | |
4666 previous contents also available (like it's done for deleting). What | |
4667 register names to use? g"1, g"2, etc.? | |
4668 - When appending to a register, also report the total resulting number of | |
4669 lines. Or just say "99 more lines yanked", add the "more". | |
4670 - When inserting a register in Insert mode with CTRL-R, don't insert comment | |
4671 leader when line wraps? | |
4672 - The ":@r" commands should take a range and execute the register for each | |
4673 line in the range. | |
4674 - Add "P" command to insert contents of unnamed register, move selected text | |
4675 to position of previous deleted (to swap foo and bar in " + foo") | |
4676 8 Should be able to yank and delete into the "/ register. | |
4677 How to take care of the flags (offset, magic)? | |
8 | 4678 |
7 | 4679 |
4680 Debug mode: | |
4681 7 Add something to enable debugging when a remote message is received. | |
4682 8 Add breakpoints for setting an option | |
9 | 4683 8 Add breakpoints for assigning to a variable. |
7 | 4684 7 Add a watchpoint in the debug mode: An expression that breaks execution |
23 | 4685 when evaluating to non-zero. Add the "watchadd expr" command, stop when |
4686 the value of the expression changes. ":watchdel" deletes an item, | |
4687 ":watchlist" lists the items. (Charles Campbell) | |
7 | 4688 7 Store the history from debug mode in viminfo. |
4689 7 Make the debug mode history available with histget() et al. | |
4690 | |
4691 | |
4692 Various improvements: | |
2642 | 4693 9 Python: be able to define a Python function that can be called directly |
4694 from Vim script. Requires converting the arguments and return value. | |
667 | 4695 7 Add plugins for formatting? Should be able to make a choice depending on |
4696 the language of a file (English/Korean/Japanese/etc.). | |
4697 Setting the 'langformat' option to "chinese" would load the | |
4698 "format/chinese.vim" plugin. | |
4699 The plugin would set 'formatexpr' and define the function being called. | |
4700 Edward L. Fox explains how it should be done for most Asian languages. | |
4701 (2005 Nov 24) | |
1624 | 4702 Alternative: patch for utf-8 line breaking. (Yongwei Wu, 2008 Feb 23) |
432 | 4703 7 [t to move to previous xml/html tag (like "vatov"), ]t to move to next |
4704 ("vatv"). | |
436 | 4705 7 [< to move to previous xml/html tag, e.g., previous <li>. ]< to move to |
4706 next <li>, ]< to next </li>, [< to previous </li>. | |
7 | 4707 8 Add ":rename" command: rename the file of the current buffer and rename |
4708 the buffer. Buffer may be modified. | |
1125 | 4709 7 Instead of filtering errors with a shell script it should be possible to |
4710 do this with Vim script. A function that filters the raw text that comes | |
4711 from the 'makeprg'? | |
651 | 4712 - Add %b to 'errorformat': buffer number. (Yegappan Lakshmanan / Suresh |
41 | 4713 Govindachar) |
1125 | 4714 7 Add a command that goes back to the position from before jumping to the |
4715 first quickfix location. ":cbefore"? | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4716 7 Allow a window not to have a statusline. Makes it possible to use a |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4717 window as a buffer-tab selection. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4718 8 Allow non-active windows to have a different statusline. (Yakov Lerner) |
7 | 4719 6 Python interface: add vim.message() function. (Michal Vitecek, 2002 Nov 5) |
4720 7 Support using ":vert" with User commands. Add expandable items <vert>. | |
4721 Do the same for ":browse" and ":confirm"? | |
4722 For ":silent" and ":debug" apply to the whole user command. | |
1624 | 4723 More general: need a way to access command modifiers in a user command. |
4724 Assign them to a v: variable? | |
7 | 4725 7 Add an invisible buffer which can be edited. For use in scripts that want |
4726 to manipulate text without changing the window layout. | |
4727 8 Add a command to revert to the saved version of file; undo or redo until | |
4728 all changes are gone. | |
4729 6 "vim -q -" should read the list of errors from stdin. (Gautam Mudunuri) | |
4730 8 Add "--remote-fail": When contacting the server fails, exit Vim. | |
4731 Add "--remote-self": When contacting the server fails, do it in this Vim. | |
4732 Overrules the default of "--remote-send" to fail and "--remote" to do it | |
4733 in this Vim. | |
4734 8 When Vim was started without a server, make it possible to start one, as | |
237 | 4735 if the "--servername" argument was given. ":startserver <name>"? |
7 | 4736 8 No address range can be used before the command modifiers. This makes |
4737 them difficult to use in a menu for Visual mode. Accept the range and | |
4738 have it apply to the following command. | |
4739 8 Add the possibility to set 'fileformats' to force a format and strip other | |
4740 CR characters. For example, for "dos" files remove CR characters at the | |
4741 end of the line, so that a file with mixed line endings is cleaned up. | |
4742 To just not display the CR characters: Add a flag to 'display'? | |
4743 7 Some compilers give error messages in which the file name does not have a | |
4744 path. Be able to specify that 'path' is used for these files. | |
4745 7 Xterm sends <Esc>O3F for <M-End>. Similarly for other <M-Home>, <M-Left>, | |
4746 etc. Combinations of Alt, Ctrl and Shift are also possible. Recognize | |
4747 these to avoid inserting the raw byte sequence, handle like the key | |
4748 without modifier (unless mapped). | |
4749 6 Add "gG": like what "gj" is to "j": go to the N'th window line. | |
4750 8 Add command like ":normal" that accepts <Key> notation like ":map". | |
4751 9 Support ACLs on more systems. | |
4752 7 Add ModeMsgVisual, ModeMsgInsert, etc. so that each mode message can be | |
4753 highlighted differently. | |
4754 7 Add a message area for the user. Set some option to reserve space (above | |
4755 the command line?). Use an ":echouser" command to display the message | |
4756 (truncated to fit in the space). | |
4757 7 Add %s to 'keywordprg': replace with word under the cursor. (Zellner) | |
4758 8 Support printing on Unix. Can use "lpansi.c" as an example. (Bookout) | |
4759 8 Add put command that replaces the text under it. Esp. for blockwise | |
4760 Visual mode. | |
8 | 4761 7 Enhance termresponse stuff: Add t_CV(?): pattern of term response, use |
7 | 4762 regexp: "\e\[[>?][0-9;]*c", but only check just after sending t_RV. |
4763 7 Add "g|" command: move to N'th column from the left margin (after wrapping | |
4764 and applying 'leftcol'). Works as "|" like what "g0" is to "0". | |
4765 7 Support setting 'equalprg' to a user function name. | |
4766 7 Highlight the characters after the end-of-line differently. | |
4767 7 When 'whichwrap' contains "l", "$dl" should join lines? | |
4768 8 Add an argument to configure to use $CFLAGS and not modify it? (Mooney) | |
4769 8 Enabling features is a mix of configure arguments and defines in | |
4770 feature.h. How to make this consistent? Feature.h is required for | |
4771 non-unix systems. Perhaps let configure define CONF_XXX, and use #ifdef | |
4772 CONF_XXX in feature.h? Then what should min-features and max-features do? | |
4773 8 Add "g^E" and "g^Y", to scroll a screen-full line up and down. | |
4774 6 Add ":timer" command, to set a command to be executed at a certain | |
4775 interval, or once after some time has elapsed. (Aaron) | |
620 | 4776 Perhaps an autocommand event like CursorHold is better? |
7 | 4777 8 Add ":confirm" handling in open_exfile(), for when file already exists. |
4778 8 When quitting with changed files, make the dialog list the changed file | |
4779 and allow "write all", "discard all", "write some". The last one would | |
4780 then ask "write" or "discard" for each changed file. Patch in HierAssist | |
4781 does something like this. (Shah) | |
4782 7 Use growarray for replace stack. | |
4783 7 Have a look at viH (Hellenic or Greek version of Vim). But a solution | |
4784 outside of Vim might be satisfactory (Haritsis). | |
4785 3 Make "2d%" work like "d%d%" instead of "d2%"? | |
4786 7 "g CTRL-O" jumps back to last used buffer. Skip CTRL-O jumps in the same | |
4787 buffer. Make jumplist remember the last ten accessed buffers? | |
2662 | 4788 7 Make it possible to set the size of the jumplist (also to a smaller number |
4789 than the default). (Nikolai Weibull) | |
7 | 4790 - Add code to disable the CAPS key when going from Insert to Normal mode. |
4791 - Set date/protection/etc. of the patchfile the same as the original file. | |
4792 - Use growarray for termcodes[] in term.c | |
4793 - Add <window-99>, like <cword> but use filename of 99'th window. | |
4794 7 Add a way to change an operator to always work characterwise-inclusive | |
4795 (like "v" makes the operator characterwise-exclusive). "x" could be used. | |
4796 - Make a set of operations on list of names: expand wildcards, replace home | |
4797 dir, append a string, delete a string, etc. | |
2587 | 4798 - Remove using mktemp() and use tmpname() only? Ctags does this. |
7 | 4799 - When replacing environment variables, and there is one that is not set, |
4800 turn it into an empty string? Only when expanding options? (Hiebert) | |
4801 - Option to set command to be executed instead of producing a beep (e.g. to | |
4802 call "play newbeep.au"). | |
4803 - Add option to show the current function name in the status line. More or | |
4804 less what you find with "[[k", like how 'cindent' recognizes a function. | |
4805 (Bhatt). | |
4806 - "[r" and "]r": like "p" and "P", but replace instead of insert (esp. for | |
4807 blockwise registers). | |
4808 - Add 'timecheck' option, on by default. Makes it possible to switch off the | |
4809 timestamp warning and question. (Dodt). | |
4810 - Add an option to set the time after which Vim should check the timestamps | |
4811 of the files. Only check when an event occurs (e.g., character typed, | |
4812 mouse moved). Useful for non-GUI versions where keyboard focus isn't | |
4813 noticeable. | |
4814 - Make 'smartcase' work even though 'ic' isn't set (Webb). | |
4815 7 When formatting text, allow to break the line at a number of characters. | |
4816 Use an option for this: 'breakchars'? Useful for formatting Fortran code. | |
4817 - Add flag to 'formatoptions' to be able to format book-style paragraphs | |
4818 (first line of paragraph has larger indent, no empty lines between | |
4819 paragraphs). Complements the '2' flag. Use '>' flag when larger indent | |
4820 starts a new paragraph, use '<' flag when smaller indent starts a new | |
4821 paragraph. Both start a new paragraph on any indent change. | |
1125 | 4822 8 The 'a' flag in 'formatoptions' is too dangerous. In some way only do |
4823 auto-formatting in specific regions, e.g. defined by syntax highlighting. | |
7 | 4824 8 Allow using a trailing space to signal a paragraph that continues on the |
4825 next line (MIME text/plain; format=flowed, RFC 2646). Can be used for | |
4826 continuous formatting. Could use 'autoformat' option, which specifies a | |
4827 regexp which triggers auto-formatting (for one line). | |
4828 ":set autoformat=\\s$". | |
4829 - Be able to redefine where a sentence stops. Use a regexp pattern? | |
169 | 4830 - Support multi-byte characters for sentences. Example from Ben Peterson. |
7 | 4831 7 Add command "g)" to go to the end of a sentence, "g(" to go back to the |
4832 end of a sentence. (Servatius Brandt) | |
4833 - Be able to redefine where a paragraph starts. For "[[" where the '{' is | |
4834 not in column 1. | |
4835 6 Add ":cdprev": go back to the previous directory. Need to remember a | |
4836 stack of previous directories. We also need ":cdnext". | |
4837 7 Should ":cd" for MS-DOS go to $HOME, when it's defined? | |
4838 - Make "gq<CR>" work on the last line in the file. Maybe for every operator? | |
4839 - Add more redirecting of Ex commands: | |
121 | 4840 :redir #> bufname |
4841 :redir #>> bufname (append) | |
162 | 4842 - Give error message when starting :redir: twice or using END when no |
4843 redirection was active. | |
7 | 4844 - Setting of options, specifically for a buffer or window, with |
4845 ":set window.option" or ":set buffer.option=val". Or use ":buffer.set". | |
4846 Also: "buffer.map <F1> quit". | |
4847 6 Would it be possible to change the color of the cursor in the Win32 | |
4848 console? (Klaus Hast) | |
4849 - Add :delcr command: | |
4850 *:delcr* | |
4851 :[range]delcr[!] Check [range] lines (default: whole buffer) for lines | |
4852 ending in <CR>. If all lines end in <CR>, or [!] is | |
4853 used, remove the <CR> at the end of lines in [range]. | |
4854 A CTRL-Z at the end of the file is removed. If | |
4855 [range] is omitted, or it is the whole file, and all | |
4856 lines end in <CR> 'textmode' is set. {not in Vi} | |
4857 - Should integrate addstar() and file_pat_to_reg_pat(). | |
4858 - When working over a serial line with 7 bit characters, remove meta | |
4859 characters from 'isprint'. | |
4860 - Use fchdir() in init_homedir(), like in FullName(). | |
4861 - In win_update(), when the GUI is active, always use the scrolling area. | |
4862 Avoid that the last status line is deleted and needs to be redrawn. | |
4863 - That "cTx" fails when the cursor is just after 'x' is Vi compatible, but | |
4864 may not be what you expect. Add a flag in 'cpoptions' for this? More | |
4865 general: Add an option to allow "c" to work with a null motion. | |
4866 - Give better error messages by using errno (strerror()). | |
4867 - Give "Usage:" error message when command used with wrong arguments (like | |
4868 Nvi). | |
4869 - Make 'restorescreen' option also work for xterm (and others), replaces the | |
4870 SAVE_XTERM_SCREEN define. | |
4871 7 Support for ":winpos" In xterm: report the current window position. | |
4872 - Give warning message when using ":set t_xx=asdf" for a termcap code that | |
4873 Vim doesn't know about. Add flag in 'shortmess'? | |
4874 6 Add ":che <file>", list all the include paths which lead to this file. | |
4875 - For a commandline that has several commands (:s, :d, etc.) summarize the | |
4876 changes all together instead of for each command (e.g. for the rot13 | |
4877 macro). | |
4878 - Add command like "[I" that also shows the tree of included files. | |
4879 - ":set sm^L" results in ":set s", because short names of options are also | |
4880 expanded. Is there a better way to do this? | |
4881 - Add ":@!" command, to ":@" like what ":source!" is to ":source". | |
4882 8 Add ":@:!": repeat last command with forceit set. | |
4883 - Add 't_normal': Used whenever t_me, t_se, t_ue or t_Zr is empty. | |
4884 - ":cab map test ^V| je", ":cunab map" doesn't work. This is vi compatible! | |
4885 - CTRL-W CTRL-E and CTRL-W CTRL-Y should move the current window up or down | |
4886 if it is not the first or last window. | |
4887 - Include-file-search commands should look in the loaded buffer of a file (if | |
4888 there is one) instead of the file itself. | |
4889 7 Change 'nrformats' to include the leader for each format. Example: | |
4890 nrformats=hex:$,binary:b,octal:0 | |
4891 Add setting of 'nrformats' to syntax files. | |
4892 - 'path' can become very long, don't use NameBuff for expansion. | |
4893 - When unhiding a hidden buffer, put the same line at top of the window as | |
237 | 4894 the one before hiding it. Or: keep the same relative cursor position (so |
7 | 4895 many percent down the windows). |
4896 - Make it possible for the 'showbreak' to be displayed at the end of the | |
4897 line. Use a comma to separate the part at the end and the start of the | |
4898 line? Highlight the linebreak characters, add flag in 'highlight'. | |
4899 - Some string options should be expanded if they have wildcards, e.g. | |
4900 'dictionary' when it is "*.h". | |
4901 - Use a specific type for number and boolean options, making it possible to | |
4902 change it for specific machines (e.g. when a long is 64 bit). | |
4903 - Add option for <Insert> in replace mode going to normal mode. (Nugent) | |
4904 - Add a next/previous possibility to "[^I" and friends. | |
4905 - Add possibility to change the HOME directory. Use the directory from the | |
4906 passwd file? (Antwerpen) | |
4907 8 Add commands to push and pop all or individual options. ":setpush tw", | |
4908 ":setpop tw", ":setpush all". Maybe pushing/popping all options is | |
4909 sufficient. ":setflush" resets the option stack? | |
4910 How to handle an aborted mapping? Remember position in tag stack when | |
4911 mapping starts, restore it when an error aborts the mapping? | |
4912 - Change ":fixdel" into option 'fixdel', t_del will be adjusted each time | |
4913 t_bs is set? (Webb) | |
4914 - "gc": goto character, move absolute character positions forward, also | |
237 | 4915 counting newlines. "gC" goes backwards (Weigert). |
4916 - When doing CTRL-^, redraw buffer with the same topline. (Demirel) Store | |
7 | 4917 cursor row and window height to redraw cursor at same percentage of window |
4918 (Webb). | |
4919 - Besides remembering the last used line number of a file, also remember the | |
237 | 4920 column. Use it with CTRL-^ et. al. |
7 | 4921 - Check for non-digits when setting a number option (careful when entering |
4922 hex codes like 0xff). | |
4923 - Add option to make "." redo the "@r" command, instead of the last command | |
4924 executed by it. Also to make "." redo the whole mapping. Basically: redo | |
4925 the last TYPED command. | |
4926 - Support URL links for ^X^F in Insert mode, like for "gf". | |
4927 - Support %name% expansion for "gf" on Windows. | |
4928 - Make "gf" work on "file://c:/path/name". "file:/c:/" and "file:///c:/" | |
4929 should also work? | |
4930 - Add 'urlpath', used like 'path' for when "gf" used on an URL? | |
4931 8 When using "gf" on an absolute file name, while editing a remote file | |
4932 (starts with scp:// or http://) should prepend the method and machine | |
4933 name. | |
4934 - When finding an URL or file name, and it doesn't exist, try removing a | |
4935 trailing '.'. | |
4936 - Add ":path" command modifier. Should work for every command that takes a | |
4937 file name argument, to search for the file name in 'path'. Use | |
4938 find_file_in_path(). | |
4939 - Highlight control characters on the screen: Shows the difference between | |
4940 CTRL-X and "^" followed by "X" (Colon). | |
4941 - Integrate parsing of cmdline command and parsing for expansion. | |
4942 - Create a program that can translate a .swp file from any machine into a | |
4943 form usable by Vim on the current machine. | |
4944 - Add ":noro" command: Reset 'ro' flag for all buffers, except ones that have | |
237 | 4945 a readonly file. ":noro!" will reset all 'ro' flags. |
7 | 4946 - Add a variant of CTRL-V that stops interpretation of more than one |
4947 character. For entering mappings on the command line where a key contains | |
4948 several special characters, e.g. a trailing newline. | |
237 | 4949 - Add regex for 'paragraphs' and 'sections': 'parare' and 'sectre'. Combine |
7 | 4950 the two into a regex for searching. (Ned Konz) |
4951 - Make '2' option in 'formatoptions' also work inside comments. | |
4952 - Add 's' flag to 'formatoptions': Do not break when inside a string. (Dodt) | |
4953 - When window size changed (with the mouse) and made too small, set it back | |
4954 to the minimal size. | |
4955 - Add "]>" and "[<", shift comment at end of line (command; /* comment */). | |
4956 - Should not call cursorcmd() for each vgetc() in getcmdline(). | |
4957 - ":split file1 file2" adds two more windows (Webb). | |
4958 - Don't give message "Incomplete last line" when editing binary file. | |
4959 - Add ":a", ":i" for preloading of named buffers. | |
4960 - When entering text, keep other windows on same buffer updated (when a line | |
4961 entered)? | |
4962 - Check out how screen does output optimizing. Apparently this is possible | |
4963 as an output filter. | |
237 | 4964 - In dosub() regexec is called twice for the same line. Try to avoid this. |
7 | 4965 - Window updating from memline.c: insert/delete/replace line. |
4966 - Optimize ml_append() for speed, esp. for reading a file. | |
4967 - V..c should keep indent when 'ai' is set, just like [count]cc. | |
4968 - Updatescript() can be done faster with a string instead of a char. | |
4969 - Screen updating is inefficient with CTRL-F and CTRL-B when there are long | |
4970 lines. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
4971 - Uppercase characters in Ex commands can be made lowercase? |
7 | 4972 8 Add option to show characters in text not as "|A" but as decimal ("^129"), |
4973 hex ("\x81") or octal ("\201") or meta (M-x). Nvi has the 'octal' option | |
4974 to switch from hex to octal. Vile can show unprintable characters in hex | |
4975 or in octal. | |
4976 7 Tighter integration with xxd to edit binary files. Make it more | |
4977 easy/obvious to use. Command line argument? | |
237 | 4978 - How does vi detect whether a filter has messed up the screen? Check source. |
7 | 4979 After ":w !command" a wait_return? |
4980 - Improve screen updating code for doput() (use s_ins()). | |
4981 - With 'p' command on last line: scroll screen up (also for terminals without | |
4982 insert line command). | |
4983 - Use insert/delete char when terminal supports it. | |
4984 - Optimize screen redraw for slow terminals. | |
4985 - Optimize "dw" for long row of spaces (say, 30000). | |
4986 - Add "-d null" for editing from a script file without displaying. | |
4987 - In Insert mode: Remember the characters that were removed with backspace | |
4988 and re-insert them one at a time with <key1>, all together with <key2>. | |
237 | 4989 - Amiga: Add possibility to set a keymap. The code in amiga.c does not work |
7 | 4990 yet. |
4991 - Implement 'redraw' option. | |
4992 - Add special code to 'sections' option to define something else but '{' or | |
4993 '}' as the start of a section (e.g. one shiftwidth to the right). | |
4994 7 Allow using Vim in a pipe: "ls | vim -u xxx.vim - | yyy". Only needs | |
4995 implementing ":w" to stdout in the buffer that was read from stdin. | |
231 | 4996 Perhaps writing to stdout will work, since stderr is used for the terminal |
4997 I/O. | |
7 | 4998 8 Allow opening an unnamed buffer with ":e !cmd" and ":sp !cmd". Vile can |
4999 do it. | |
5000 - Add commands like ]] and [[ that do not include the line jumped to. | |
5001 - When :unab without matching "from" part and several matching "to" parts, | |
5002 delete the entry that was used last, instead of the first in the list. | |
5003 - Add text justification option. | |
5004 - Set boolean options on/off with ":set paste=off", ":set paste=on". | |
5005 - After "inv"ing an option show the value: ":set invpaste" gives "paste is | |
5006 off". | |
5007 - Check handling of CTRL-V and '\' for ":" commands that do not have TRLBAR. | |
5008 - When a file cannot be opened but does exist, give error message. | |
5009 - Amiga: When 'r' protection bit is not set, file can still be opened but | |
237 | 5010 gives read errors. Check protection before opening. |
7 | 5011 - When writing check for file exists but no permission, "Permission denied". |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2206
diff
changeset
|
5012 - If file does not exist, check if directory exists. |
7 | 5013 - MSDOS: although t_cv and t_ci are not set, do invert char under cursor. |
5014 - Settings edit mode: make file with ":set opt=xx", edit it, parse it as ex | |
5015 commands. | |
5016 - ":set -w all": list one option per line. | |
5017 - Amiga: test for 'w' flag when reading a file. | |
5018 - :table command (Webb) | |
5019 - Add new operator: clear, make area white (replace with spaces): "g ". | |
5020 - Add command to ":read" a file at a certain column (blockwise read?). | |
5021 - Add sort of replace mode where case is taken from the old text (Goldfarb). | |
5022 - Allow multiple arguments for ":read", read all the files. | |
5023 - Support for tabs in specific columns: ":set tabcol=8,20,34,56" (Demirel). | |
5024 - Add 'searchdir' option: Directories to search for file name being edited | |
5025 (Demirel). | |
5026 - Modifier for the put command: Change to linewise, charwise, blockwise, etc. | |
5027 - Add commands for saving and restoring options ":set save" "set restore", | |
5028 for use in macro's and the like. | |
5029 - Keep output from listings in a window, so you can have a look at it while | |
237 | 5030 working in another window. Put cmdline in a separate window? |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1702
diff
changeset
|
5031 - Add possibility to put output of Ex commands in a buffer or file, e.g. for |
7 | 5032 ":set all". ":r :set all"? |
5033 - When the 'equalalways' option is set, creating a new window should not | |
237 | 5034 result in windows to become bigger. Deleting a window should not result in |
7 | 5035 a window to become smaller (Webb). |
5036 - When resizing the whole Vim window, the windows inside should be resized | |
5037 proportionally (Webb). | |
237 | 5038 - Include options directly in option table, no indirect pointers. Use |
7 | 5039 mkopttab to make option table? |
5040 - When doing ":w dir", where "dir" is a directory name, write the current | |
5041 file into that directory, with the current file name (without the path)? | |
5042 - Support for 'dictionary's that are sorted, makes access a lot faster | |
5043 (Haritsis). | |
237 | 5044 - Add "^Vrx" on the command line, replace with contents of register x. Used |
7 | 5045 instead of CTRL-R to make repeating possible. (Marinichev) |
5046 - Add "^Vb" on the command line, replace with word before or under the | |
5047 cursor? | |
5048 - Option to make a .swp file only when a change is made (Templeton). | |
5049 - Support mapping for replace mode and "r" command (Vi doesn't do this)? | |
5050 5 Add 'ignorefilecase' option: Ignore case when expanding file names. | |
5051 ":e ma<Tab>" would also find "Makefile" on Unix. | |
9 | 5052 8 Sorting of filenames for completion is wrong on systems that ignore |
5053 case of filenames. Add 'ignorefncase' option. When set, case in | |
5054 filenames is ignored for sorting them. Patch by Mike Williams: | |
5055 ~/vim/patches/ignorefncase. Also change what matches? Or use another | |
5056 option name. | |
7 | 5057 8 Should be able to compile Vim in another directory, with $(srcdir) set to |
5058 where the sources are. Add $(srcdir) in the Makefile in a lot of places. | |
5059 (Netherton) | |
5060 6 Make it configurable when "J" inserts a space or not. Should not add a | |
5061 space after "(", for example. | |
5062 5 When inserting spaces after the end-of-line for 'virtualedit', use tabs | |
5063 when the user wants this (e.g., add a "tab" field to 'virtualedit'). | |
5064 (Servatius Brandt) | |
5065 | |
5066 | |
5067 From Elvis: | |
5068 - Use "instman.sh" to install manpages? | |
5069 - Add ":alias" command. | |
5070 - Search patterns: | |
5071 \@ match word under cursor. | |
5072 but do: | |
5073 \@w match the word under the cursor? | |
5074 \@W match the WORD under the cursor? | |
5075 8 ":window" command: | |
5076 :win + next window (up) | |
5077 :win ++ idem, wrapping | |
5078 :win - previous window (down) | |
5079 :win -- idem, wrapping | |
5080 :win nr to window number "nr" | |
5081 :win name to window editing buffer "name" | |
5082 7 ":cc" compiles a single file (default: current one). 'ccprg' option is | |
5083 program to use with ":cc". Use ":compile" instead of ":cc"? | |
5084 | |
5085 | |
5086 From xvi: | |
5087 - CTRL-_ : swap 8th bit of character. | |
5088 - Add egrep-like regex type, like xvi (Ned Konz) or Perl (Emmanuel Mogenet) | |
5089 | |
5090 | |
5091 From vile: | |
5092 - When horizontal scrolling, use '>' for lines continuing right of a window. | |
5093 - Support putting .swp files in /tmp: Command in rc.local to move .swp files | |
5094 from /tmp to some directory before deleting files. | |
5095 | |
5096 | |
5097 Far future and "big" extensions: | |
541 | 5098 - Instead of using a Makefile and autoconf, use a simple shell script to |
5099 find the C compiler and do everything with C code. Translate something | |
5100 like an Aap recipe and configure.in to C. Avoids depending on Python, | |
5101 thus will work everywhere. With batch file to find the C compiler it | |
5102 would also work on MS-Windows. | |
7 | 5103 - Make it easy to setup Vim for groups of users: novice vi users, novice |
5104 Vim users, C programmers, xterm users, GUI users,... | |
5105 - Change layout of blocks in swap file: Text at the start, with '\n' in | |
5106 between lines (just load the file without changes, except for Mac). | |
5107 Indexes for lines are from the end of the block backwards. It's the | |
5108 current layout mirrored. | |
5109 - Make it possible to edit a register, in a window, like a buffer. | |
5110 - Add stuff to syntax highlighting to change the text (upper-case keywords, | |
5111 set indent, define other highlighting, etc.). | |
5112 - Mode to keep C-code formatted all the time (sort of on-line indent). | |
5113 - Several top-level windows in one Vim session. Be able to use a different | |
5114 font in each top-level window. | |
5115 - Allow editing above start and below end of buffer (flag in 'virtualedit'). | |
5116 - Smart cut/paste: recognize words and adjust spaces before/after them. | |
5117 - Add open mode, use it when terminal has no cursor positioning. | |
5118 - Special "drawing mode": a line is drawn where the cursor is moved to. | |
5119 Backspace deletes along the line (from jvim). | |
5120 - Implement ":Bset", set option in all buffers. Also ":Wset", set in all | |
5121 windows, ":Aset, set in all arguments and ":Tset", set in all files | |
5122 mentioned in the tags file. | |
5123 Add buffer/arg range, like in ":2,5B%s/..." (do we really need this???) | |
5124 Add search string: "B/*.c/%s/.."? Or ":F/*.c/%s/.."? | |
5125 - Support for underlining (underscore-BS-char), bold (char-BS-char) and other | |
5126 standout modes switched on/off with , 'overstrike' option (Reiter). | |
5127 - Add vertical mode (Paul Jury, Demirel): "5vdw" deletes a word in five | |
5128 lines, "3vitextESC" will insert "text" in three lines, etc.. | |
5129 4 Recognize l, #, p as 'flags' to EX commands: | |
5130 :g/RE/#l shall print lines with line numbers and in list format. | |
5131 :g/RE/dp shall print lines that are deleted. | |
5132 POSIX: Commands where flags shall apply to all lines written: list, | |
237 | 5133 number, open, print, substitute, visual, &, z. For other commands, flags |
7 | 5134 shall apply to the current line after the command completes. Examples: |
5135 :7,10j #l Join the lines 7-10 and print the result in list | |
5136 - Allow two or more users to edit the same file at the same time. Changes | |
5137 are reflected in each Vim immediately. Could work with local files but | |
5138 also over the internet. See http://www.codingmonkeys.de/subethaedit/. | |
5139 | |
648 | 5140 When using "do" or ":diffget" in a buffer with changes in every line an extra |
5141 empty line would appear. | |
7 | 5142 |
5143 vim:tw=78:sw=4:sts=4:ts=8:ft=help:norl: | |
5144 vim: set fo+=n : |